1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 35 #include <algorithm> 36 #include <cstdlib> 37 38 using namespace clang; 39 using namespace sema; 40 41 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 42 static ExprResult 43 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 44 bool HadMultipleCandidates, 45 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 46 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 47 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 48 return ExprError(); 49 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 50 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 51 // called on both. 52 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 53 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 54 // being used. 55 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 56 return ExprError(); 57 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(), 58 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 59 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 60 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 61 62 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 63 64 ExprResult E = DRE; 65 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.get()); 66 if (E.isInvalid()) 67 return ExprError(); 68 return E; 69 } 70 71 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 72 bool InOverloadResolution, 73 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 74 bool CStyle, 75 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 76 77 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 78 QualType &ToType, 79 bool InOverloadResolution, 80 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 81 bool CStyle); 82 static OverloadingResult 83 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 84 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 85 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 86 bool AllowExplicit, 87 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 88 89 90 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 91 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 92 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 93 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 94 95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 96 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 98 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 99 100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 101 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 104 105 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 106 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 107 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 108 static const ImplicitConversionRank 109 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 110 ICR_Exact_Match, 111 ICR_Exact_Match, 112 ICR_Exact_Match, 113 ICR_Exact_Match, 114 ICR_Exact_Match, 115 ICR_Exact_Match, 116 ICR_Promotion, 117 ICR_Promotion, 118 ICR_Promotion, 119 ICR_Conversion, 120 ICR_Conversion, 121 ICR_Conversion, 122 ICR_Conversion, 123 ICR_Conversion, 124 ICR_Conversion, 125 ICR_Conversion, 126 ICR_Conversion, 127 ICR_Conversion, 128 ICR_Conversion, 129 ICR_Conversion, 130 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Writeback_Conversion 134 }; 135 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 136 } 137 138 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 139 /// implicit conversion. 140 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 141 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 142 "No conversion", 143 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 144 "Array-to-pointer", 145 "Function-to-pointer", 146 "Noreturn adjustment", 147 "Qualification", 148 "Integral promotion", 149 "Floating point promotion", 150 "Complex promotion", 151 "Integral conversion", 152 "Floating conversion", 153 "Complex conversion", 154 "Floating-integral conversion", 155 "Pointer conversion", 156 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 157 "Boolean conversion", 158 "Compatible-types conversion", 159 "Derived-to-base conversion", 160 "Vector conversion", 161 "Vector splat", 162 "Complex-real conversion", 163 "Block Pointer conversion", 164 "Transparent Union Conversion", 165 "Writeback conversion" 166 }; 167 return Name[Kind]; 168 } 169 170 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 171 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 172 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 173 First = ICK_Identity; 174 Second = ICK_Identity; 175 Third = ICK_Identity; 176 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 177 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 178 ReferenceBinding = false; 179 DirectBinding = false; 180 IsLvalueReference = true; 181 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 182 BindsToRvalue = false; 183 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 184 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 185 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 186 } 187 188 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 189 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 190 /// implicit conversions. 191 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 192 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 193 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 194 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 195 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 196 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 197 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 198 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 199 return Rank; 200 } 201 202 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 203 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 204 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 205 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 206 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 207 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 208 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 209 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 210 // a pointer. 211 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 212 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 213 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 214 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 215 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 216 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 217 return true; 218 219 return false; 220 } 221 222 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 223 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 224 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 225 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 226 bool 227 StandardConversionSequence:: 228 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 229 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 230 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 231 232 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 233 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 234 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 235 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 236 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 237 238 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 239 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 240 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 241 242 return false; 243 } 244 245 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 246 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 247 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) { 248 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 249 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 250 case CK_NoOp: 251 case CK_IntegralCast: 252 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 253 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 254 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 255 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 256 case CK_FloatingCast: 257 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 258 continue; 259 260 default: 261 return Converted; 262 } 263 } 264 265 return Converted; 266 } 267 268 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 269 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 270 /// 271 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 272 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 273 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 274 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 275 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 276 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 277 NarrowingKind 278 StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx, 279 const Expr *Converted, 280 APValue &ConstantValue, 281 QualType &ConstantType) const { 282 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 283 284 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 285 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 286 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 287 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 288 switch (Second) { 289 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 290 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 291 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 292 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 293 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 294 goto IntegralConversion; 295 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 296 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 297 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 298 299 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 300 // 301 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 302 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 303 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 304 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 305 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 306 FloatingIntegralConversion: 307 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 308 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 309 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 310 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 311 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 312 if (Initializer && 313 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 314 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 315 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 316 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 317 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 318 // And back. 319 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 320 bool ignored; 321 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 322 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 323 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 324 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 325 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 326 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 327 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 328 } 329 } else { 330 // Variables are always narrowings. 331 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 332 } 333 } 334 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 335 336 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 337 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 338 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 339 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 340 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 341 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 342 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 343 // FromType is larger than ToType. 344 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 345 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 346 // Constant! 347 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 348 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 349 // Convert the source value into the target type. 350 bool ignored; 351 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 352 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 353 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 354 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 355 // values that can be represented. 356 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 357 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 358 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 359 } 360 } else { 361 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 362 } 363 } 364 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 365 366 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 367 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 368 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 369 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 370 // value when converted back to the original type. 371 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 372 IntegralConversion: { 373 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 374 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 375 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 376 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 377 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 378 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 379 380 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 381 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 382 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 383 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 384 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 385 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 386 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 387 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 388 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 389 } 390 bool Narrowing = false; 391 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 392 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 393 // narrowing. 394 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 395 Narrowing = true; 396 } else { 397 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 398 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 399 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 400 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 401 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 402 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 403 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 404 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 405 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 406 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 407 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 408 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 409 Narrowing = true; 410 } 411 if (Narrowing) { 412 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 413 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 414 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 415 } 416 } 417 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 418 } 419 420 default: 421 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 422 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 423 } 424 } 425 426 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 427 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 428 void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 429 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 430 bool PrintedSomething = false; 431 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 432 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 433 PrintedSomething = true; 434 } 435 436 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 437 if (PrintedSomething) { 438 OS << " -> "; 439 } 440 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 441 442 if (CopyConstructor) { 443 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 444 } else if (DirectBinding) { 445 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 446 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 447 OS << " (reference binding)"; 448 } 449 PrintedSomething = true; 450 } 451 452 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 453 if (PrintedSomething) { 454 OS << " -> "; 455 } 456 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 457 PrintedSomething = true; 458 } 459 460 if (!PrintedSomething) { 461 OS << "No conversions required"; 462 } 463 } 464 465 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 466 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 467 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 468 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 469 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 470 Before.dump(); 471 OS << " -> "; 472 } 473 if (ConversionFunction) 474 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 475 else 476 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 477 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 478 OS << " -> "; 479 After.dump(); 480 } 481 } 482 483 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 485 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 487 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 488 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 489 switch (ConversionKind) { 490 case StandardConversion: 491 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 492 Standard.dump(); 493 break; 494 case UserDefinedConversion: 495 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 496 UserDefined.dump(); 497 break; 498 case EllipsisConversion: 499 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 500 break; 501 case AmbiguousConversion: 502 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 503 break; 504 case BadConversion: 505 OS << "Bad conversion"; 506 break; 507 } 508 509 OS << "\n"; 510 } 511 512 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 513 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 514 } 515 516 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 517 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 518 } 519 520 void 521 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 522 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 523 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 524 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 525 } 526 527 namespace { 528 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 529 // template argument information. 530 struct DFIArguments { 531 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 532 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 533 }; 534 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 535 // template parameter and template argument information. 536 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 537 TemplateParameter Param; 538 }; 539 } 540 541 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 542 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 543 DeductionFailureInfo 544 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 545 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 546 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 547 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 548 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 549 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 550 Result.Data = nullptr; 551 switch (TDK) { 552 case Sema::TDK_Success: 553 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 554 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 555 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 556 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 557 break; 558 559 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 560 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 561 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 562 break; 563 564 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 565 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 566 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 567 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 568 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 569 Result.Data = Saved; 570 break; 571 } 572 573 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 574 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 575 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 576 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 577 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 578 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 579 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 580 Result.Data = Saved; 581 break; 582 } 583 584 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 585 Result.Data = Info.take(); 586 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 587 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 588 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 589 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 590 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 591 } 592 break; 593 594 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 595 Result.Data = Info.Expression; 596 break; 597 598 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 599 break; 600 } 601 602 return Result; 603 } 604 605 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 606 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 607 case Sema::TDK_Success: 608 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 609 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 610 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 611 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 612 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 613 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 614 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 615 break; 616 617 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 618 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 620 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 621 Data = nullptr; 622 break; 623 624 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 625 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 626 Data = nullptr; 627 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 628 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 629 HasDiagnostic = false; 630 } 631 break; 632 633 // Unhandled 634 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 635 break; 636 } 637 } 638 639 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 640 if (HasDiagnostic) 641 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 642 return nullptr; 643 } 644 645 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 646 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 647 case Sema::TDK_Success: 648 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 649 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 650 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 651 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 652 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 653 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 654 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 655 return TemplateParameter(); 656 657 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 658 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 659 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 660 661 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 662 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 663 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 664 665 // Unhandled 666 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 667 break; 668 } 669 670 return TemplateParameter(); 671 } 672 673 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 674 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 675 case Sema::TDK_Success: 676 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 677 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 678 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 679 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 680 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 681 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 682 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 683 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 684 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 685 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 686 return nullptr; 687 688 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 689 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 690 691 // Unhandled 692 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 693 break; 694 } 695 696 return nullptr; 697 } 698 699 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 700 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 701 case Sema::TDK_Success: 702 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 703 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 704 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 705 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 706 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 707 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 708 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 709 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 710 return nullptr; 711 712 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 713 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 714 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 715 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 716 717 // Unhandled 718 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 719 break; 720 } 721 722 return nullptr; 723 } 724 725 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 726 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 727 case Sema::TDK_Success: 728 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 729 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 730 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 731 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 732 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 733 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 734 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 735 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 736 return nullptr; 737 738 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 739 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 740 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 741 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 742 743 // Unhandled 744 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 745 break; 746 } 747 748 return nullptr; 749 } 750 751 Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() { 752 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) == 753 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution) 754 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data); 755 756 return nullptr; 757 } 758 759 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 760 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 761 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii) 762 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 763 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 764 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 765 } 766 } 767 768 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() { 769 destroyCandidates(); 770 NumInlineSequences = 0; 771 Candidates.clear(); 772 Functions.clear(); 773 } 774 775 namespace { 776 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 777 struct Entry { 778 Expr **Addr; 779 Expr *Saved; 780 }; 781 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 782 783 public: 784 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 785 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 786 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 787 Entries.push_back(entry); 788 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 789 } 790 791 void restore() { 792 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 793 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 794 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 795 } 796 }; 797 } 798 799 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 800 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 801 /// 802 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 803 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 804 /// 805 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 806 static bool 807 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 808 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 809 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 810 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 811 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 812 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 813 814 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 815 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 816 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 817 unbridgedCasts) { 818 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 819 return false; 820 } 821 822 // Go ahead and check everything else. 823 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 824 if (result.isInvalid()) 825 return true; 826 827 E = result.get(); 828 return false; 829 } 830 831 // Nothing to do. 832 return false; 833 } 834 835 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 836 /// placeholders. 837 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 838 MultiExprArg Args, 839 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 840 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 841 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 842 return true; 843 844 return false; 845 } 846 847 // IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an 848 // overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if 849 // New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same 850 // signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old 851 // declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When 852 // it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New 853 // cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on 854 // top of the underlying declaration. 855 // 856 // Example: Given the following input: 857 // 858 // void f(int, float); // #1 859 // void f(int, int); // #2 860 // int f(int, int); // #3 861 // 862 // When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", 863 // so IsOverload will not be used. 864 // 865 // When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By 866 // comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded 867 // (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns 868 // false; MatchedDecl is unchanged. 869 // 870 // When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We 871 // compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do 872 // nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are 873 // identical (return types of functions are not part of the 874 // signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to 875 // point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 876 // 877 // 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced 878 // into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide 879 // shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure 880 // into a function template's signature. 881 Sema::OverloadKind 882 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 883 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 884 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 885 I != E; ++I) { 886 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 887 888 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 889 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 890 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 891 892 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 893 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 894 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 895 896 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 897 } 898 899 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 900 // if one of them is hidden. 901 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 902 continue; 903 904 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 905 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 906 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 907 // function templates hide function templates with different 908 // return types or template parameter lists. 909 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 910 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 911 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 912 913 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 914 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 915 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 916 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 917 continue; 918 } 919 920 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 921 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 922 continue; 923 924 Match = *I; 925 return Ovl_Match; 926 } 927 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) { 928 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 929 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 930 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 931 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 932 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 933 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 934 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 935 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 936 // template instantiation. 937 } else { 938 // (C++ 13p1): 939 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 940 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 941 Match = *I; 942 return Ovl_NonFunction; 943 } 944 } 945 946 return Ovl_Overload; 947 } 948 949 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 950 bool UseUsingDeclRules) { 951 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 952 if (New->isMain()) 953 return false; 954 955 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 956 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 957 return false; 958 959 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 960 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 961 962 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 963 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 964 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 965 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 966 return true; 967 968 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 969 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 970 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 971 972 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 973 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 974 // in the signature, they are overloads. 975 976 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 977 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 978 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 979 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 980 return false; 981 982 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 983 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 984 985 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 986 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 987 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 988 if (OldQType != NewQType && 989 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 990 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 991 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 992 return true; 993 994 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 995 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 996 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 997 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 998 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 999 // signature. 1000 // 1001 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1002 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1003 // 1004 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1005 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1006 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1007 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1008 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1009 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1010 OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType())) 1011 return true; 1012 1013 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1014 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1015 // 1016 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1017 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1018 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1019 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1020 // can be overloaded. 1021 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1022 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1023 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1024 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1025 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1026 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && 1027 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1028 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1029 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1030 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1031 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1032 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1033 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1034 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1035 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1036 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1037 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1038 } 1039 return true; 1040 } 1041 1042 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1043 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1044 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1045 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1046 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1047 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1048 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1049 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1050 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const; 1051 1052 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1053 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1054 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1055 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1056 return true; 1057 } 1058 1059 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1060 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1061 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1062 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1063 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1064 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1065 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1066 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1067 return true; 1068 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1069 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1070 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1071 if (NewID != OldID) 1072 return true; 1073 } 1074 1075 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads) { 1076 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1077 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1078 if (NewTarget == CFT_InvalidTarget || NewTarget == CFT_Global) 1079 return false; 1080 1081 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && "Unexpected invalid target."); 1082 1083 // Don't allow mixing of HD with other kinds. This guarantees that 1084 // we have only one viable function with this signature on any 1085 // side of CUDA compilation . 1086 if ((NewTarget == CFT_HostDevice) || (OldTarget == CFT_HostDevice)) 1087 return false; 1088 1089 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature, but 1090 // different CUDA target attributes. 1091 return NewTarget != OldTarget; 1092 } 1093 1094 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1095 return false; 1096 } 1097 1098 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current 1099 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored. 1100 /// 1101 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside 1102 /// an available function, false otherwise. 1103 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) { 1104 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable(); 1105 } 1106 1107 /// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1108 /// 1109 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1110 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1111 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1112 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1113 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1114 bool AllowExplicit, 1115 bool InOverloadResolution, 1116 bool CStyle, 1117 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1118 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1119 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1120 1121 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1122 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1123 // we can perform. 1124 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1125 return ICS; 1126 } 1127 1128 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1129 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1130 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1131 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1132 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1133 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1134 case OR_Success: 1135 case OR_Deleted: 1136 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1137 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1138 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1139 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1140 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1141 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1142 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1143 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1144 // called for those cases. 1145 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1146 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1147 QualType FromCanon 1148 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1149 QualType ToCanon 1150 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1151 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1152 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1153 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1154 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1155 ICS.setStandard(); 1156 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1157 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1158 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1159 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1160 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1161 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1162 } 1163 } 1164 break; 1165 1166 case OR_Ambiguous: 1167 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1168 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1169 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1170 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1171 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1172 if (Cand->Viable) 1173 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 1174 break; 1175 1176 // Fall through. 1177 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1178 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1179 break; 1180 } 1181 1182 return ICS; 1183 } 1184 1185 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1186 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1187 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1188 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1189 /// 1190 /// void f(float f); 1191 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1192 /// 1193 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1194 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1195 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1196 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1197 // 1198 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1199 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1200 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1201 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1202 /// "BadConversion". 1203 /// 1204 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1205 /// not permitted. 1206 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1207 /// permitted. 1208 /// 1209 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1210 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1211 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1212 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1213 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1214 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1215 bool AllowExplicit, 1216 bool InOverloadResolution, 1217 bool CStyle, 1218 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1219 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1220 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1221 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1222 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1223 ICS.setStandard(); 1224 return ICS; 1225 } 1226 1227 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1228 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1229 return ICS; 1230 } 1231 1232 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1233 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1234 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1235 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1236 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1237 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1238 // called for those cases. 1239 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1240 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1241 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1242 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) { 1243 ICS.setStandard(); 1244 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1245 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1246 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1247 1248 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1249 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1250 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1251 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1252 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1253 1254 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1255 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1256 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1257 1258 return ICS; 1259 } 1260 1261 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1262 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1263 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1264 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1265 } 1266 1267 ImplicitConversionSequence 1268 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1269 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1270 bool AllowExplicit, 1271 bool InOverloadResolution, 1272 bool CStyle, 1273 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1274 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1275 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 1276 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1277 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1278 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1279 } 1280 1281 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1282 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1283 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1284 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1285 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1286 ExprResult 1287 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1288 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 1289 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1290 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 1291 } 1292 1293 ExprResult 1294 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1295 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 1296 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 1297 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1298 return ExprError(); 1299 1300 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1302 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1303 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1304 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) 1305 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(), 1306 ToType, From->getType(), From); 1307 ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1308 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1309 AllowExplicit, 1310 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1311 /*CStyle=*/false, 1312 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1313 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1314 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1315 } 1316 1317 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1318 /// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type. 1319 bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1320 QualType &ResultTy) { 1321 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1322 return false; 1323 1324 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1325 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1326 // - a pointer 1327 // - a member pointer 1328 // - a block pointer 1329 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1330 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1331 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1332 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1333 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1334 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1335 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1336 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1337 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1338 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1339 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1340 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1341 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1342 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1343 } else { 1344 return false; 1345 } 1346 1347 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1348 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1349 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1350 return false; 1351 } 1352 1353 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1354 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1355 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false; 1356 1357 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1358 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1359 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1360 1361 ResultTy = ToType; 1362 return true; 1363 } 1364 1365 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1366 /// vector conversion. 1367 /// 1368 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1369 /// conversion. 1370 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1371 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1372 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1373 // conversion. 1374 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1375 return false; 1376 1377 // Identical types require no conversions. 1378 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1379 return false; 1380 1381 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1382 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1383 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1384 // identity conversion. 1385 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1386 return false; 1387 1388 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1389 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1390 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1391 return true; 1392 } 1393 } 1394 1395 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1396 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1397 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1398 // same size 1399 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1400 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1401 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) { 1402 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1403 return true; 1404 } 1405 } 1406 1407 return false; 1408 } 1409 1410 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1411 bool InOverloadResolution, 1412 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1413 bool CStyle); 1414 1415 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1416 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1417 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1418 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1419 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1420 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1421 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1422 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1423 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1424 bool InOverloadResolution, 1425 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1426 bool CStyle, 1427 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1428 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1429 1430 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1431 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1432 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1433 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1434 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1435 1436 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1437 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit 1438 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) { 1439 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 1440 return false; 1441 1442 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions, 1443 } 1444 1445 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1446 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1447 // (C++ 4p1). 1448 1449 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1450 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1451 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1452 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1453 AccessPair)) { 1454 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1455 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1456 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1457 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1458 1459 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1460 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1461 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1462 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1463 QualType resultTy; 1464 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1465 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, 1466 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1467 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1468 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1469 return false; 1470 } 1471 1472 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1473 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1474 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1475 // expression. 1476 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1477 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1478 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1479 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1480 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1481 == UO_AddrOf && 1482 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1483 const Type *ClassType 1484 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1485 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1486 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1487 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1488 UO_AddrOf && 1489 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1490 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1491 } 1492 1493 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1494 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1495 FromType, 1496 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1497 } else { 1498 return false; 1499 } 1500 } 1501 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1502 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1503 // be converted to a prvalue. 1504 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1505 if (argIsLValue && 1506 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1507 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1508 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1509 1510 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1511 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1512 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1513 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1514 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1515 1516 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1517 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1518 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1519 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1520 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1521 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1522 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1523 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1524 1525 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1526 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1527 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1528 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1529 1530 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1531 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1532 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1533 1534 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1535 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1536 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1537 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1538 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1539 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1540 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1541 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1542 return true; 1543 } 1544 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1545 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1546 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1547 1548 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1549 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1550 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1551 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1552 } else { 1553 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1554 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1555 } 1556 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1557 1558 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1559 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1560 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1561 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1562 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1563 // conversion. 1564 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1565 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1566 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1567 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1568 // conversion to do. 1569 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1570 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1571 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1572 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1573 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1574 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1575 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1576 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1577 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1578 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1579 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1580 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1581 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1582 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1583 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1584 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1585 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1586 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1587 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1588 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1589 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1590 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1591 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1592 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1593 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1594 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1595 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1596 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1597 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1598 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1599 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1600 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1601 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1602 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1603 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1604 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1605 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1606 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1607 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1608 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1609 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1610 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1611 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1612 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1613 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1614 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1615 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1616 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1617 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1618 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1619 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1620 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1621 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1622 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1623 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1624 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1625 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1626 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1627 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1628 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1629 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1630 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1631 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1632 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1633 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1634 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1635 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1636 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1637 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1638 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1639 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1640 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion. 1641 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment; 1642 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1643 InOverloadResolution, 1644 SCS, CStyle)) { 1645 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1646 FromType = ToType; 1647 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1648 CStyle)) { 1649 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1650 // appropriately. 1651 return true; 1652 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1653 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1654 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1655 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1656 FromType = ToType; 1657 } else { 1658 // No second conversion required. 1659 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1660 } 1661 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1662 1663 QualType CanonFrom; 1664 QualType CanonTo; 1665 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1). 1666 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1667 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1668 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1669 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1670 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1671 FromType = ToType; 1672 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1673 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1674 } else { 1675 // No conversion required 1676 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1677 1678 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1679 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1680 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1681 // a conversion. [...] 1682 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1683 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1684 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1685 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1686 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1687 FromType = ToType; 1688 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1689 } 1690 } 1691 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1692 1693 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1694 // this is a bad conversion sequence. 1695 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo) 1696 return false; 1697 1698 return true; 1699 } 1700 1701 static bool 1702 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 1703 QualType &ToType, 1704 bool InOverloadResolution, 1705 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1706 bool CStyle) { 1707 1708 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 1709 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 1710 return false; 1711 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 1712 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 1713 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 1714 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 1715 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1716 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 1717 ToType = it->getType(); 1718 return true; 1719 } 1720 } 1721 return false; 1722 } 1723 1724 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 1725 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 1726 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 1727 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1728 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1729 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1730 // All integers are built-in. 1731 if (!To) { 1732 return false; 1733 } 1734 1735 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 1736 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 1737 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 1738 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 1739 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 1740 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 1741 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 1742 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 1743 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 1744 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 1745 // less than int to an int. 1746 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && 1747 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 1748 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1749 } 1750 1751 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1752 } 1753 1754 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 1755 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 1756 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 1757 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 1758 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 1759 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 1760 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 1761 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 1762 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 1763 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 1764 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 1765 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 1766 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 1767 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 1768 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 1769 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 1770 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 1771 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 1772 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 1773 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 1774 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 1775 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 1776 return false; 1777 1778 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 1779 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 1780 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 1781 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 1782 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 1783 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1784 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 1785 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 1786 } 1787 1788 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 1789 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 1790 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0)) 1791 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1792 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 1793 } 1794 1795 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 1796 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 1797 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 1798 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 1799 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 1800 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 1801 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 1802 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 1803 // type. 1804 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 1805 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 1806 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 1807 // unsigned. 1808 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 1809 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 1810 1811 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 1812 // order. Try each of these types. 1813 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 1814 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 1815 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 1816 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 1817 }; 1818 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 1819 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1820 if (FromSize < ToSize || 1821 (FromSize == ToSize && 1822 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 1823 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 1824 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 1825 // promotion. 1826 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 1827 } 1828 } 1829 } 1830 1831 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 1832 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 1833 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 1834 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 1835 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 1836 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 1837 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 1838 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 1839 // conversion. 1840 if (From) { 1841 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 1842 llvm::APSInt BitWidth; 1843 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 1844 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 1845 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 1846 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 1847 1848 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 1849 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 1850 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 1851 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1852 } 1853 1854 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 1855 // that fits into an unsigned int? 1856 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 1857 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1858 } 1859 1860 return false; 1861 } 1862 } 1863 } 1864 1865 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 1866 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 1867 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 1868 return true; 1869 } 1870 1871 return false; 1872 } 1873 1874 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 1875 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 1876 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1877 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1878 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 1879 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1880 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 1881 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 1882 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 1883 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 1884 return true; 1885 1886 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 1887 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 1888 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 1889 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1890 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 1891 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 1892 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)) 1893 return true; 1894 1895 // Half can be promoted to float. 1896 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 1897 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 1898 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 1899 return true; 1900 } 1901 1902 return false; 1903 } 1904 1905 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 1906 /// 1907 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 1908 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 1909 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 1910 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1911 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1912 if (!FromComplex) 1913 return false; 1914 1915 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1916 if (!ToComplex) 1917 return false; 1918 1919 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 1920 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 1921 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 1922 ToComplex->getElementType()); 1923 } 1924 1925 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 1926 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 1927 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 1928 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 1929 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 1930 /// 1931 static QualType 1932 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 1933 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 1934 ASTContext &Context, 1935 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 1936 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 1937 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 1938 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 1939 1940 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 1941 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 1942 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1943 1944 QualType CanonFromPointee 1945 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 1946 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 1947 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 1948 1949 if (StripObjCLifetime) 1950 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 1951 1952 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 1953 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 1954 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 1955 if (!ToType.isNull()) 1956 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1957 1958 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 1959 // already. 1960 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1961 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 1962 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 1963 } 1964 1965 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 1966 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 1967 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 1968 1969 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 1970 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1971 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 1972 } 1973 1974 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 1975 bool InOverloadResolution, 1976 ASTContext &Context) { 1977 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 1978 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 1979 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 1980 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 1981 return !InOverloadResolution; 1982 1983 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 1984 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 1985 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 1986 } 1987 1988 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 1989 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 1990 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 1991 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 1992 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 1993 /// ConvertedType. 1994 /// 1995 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 1996 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 1997 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 1998 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 1999 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2000 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2001 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2002 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2003 /// should result in a warning. 2004 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2005 bool InOverloadResolution, 2006 QualType& ConvertedType, 2007 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2008 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2009 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2010 IncompatibleObjC)) 2011 return true; 2012 2013 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2014 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2015 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2016 ConvertedType = ToType; 2017 return true; 2018 } 2019 2020 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2021 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2022 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2023 ConvertedType = ToType; 2024 return true; 2025 } 2026 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2027 // pointer type. 2028 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2029 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2030 ConvertedType = ToType; 2031 return true; 2032 } 2033 2034 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2035 // pointer constant. 2036 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2037 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2038 ConvertedType = ToType; 2039 return true; 2040 } 2041 2042 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2043 if (!ToTypePtr) 2044 return false; 2045 2046 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2047 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2048 ConvertedType = ToType; 2049 return true; 2050 } 2051 2052 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2053 // , including objective-c pointers. 2054 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2055 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2056 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2057 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2058 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2059 ToPointeeType, 2060 ToType, Context); 2061 return true; 2062 } 2063 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2064 if (!FromTypePtr) 2065 return false; 2066 2067 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2068 2069 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2070 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2071 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2072 return false; 2073 2074 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2075 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2076 // 4.10p2). 2077 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2078 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2079 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2080 ToPointeeType, 2081 ToType, Context, 2082 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2083 return true; 2084 } 2085 2086 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2087 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2088 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2089 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2090 ToPointeeType, 2091 ToType, Context); 2092 return true; 2093 } 2094 2095 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2096 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2097 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2098 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2099 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2100 ToPointeeType, 2101 ToType, Context); 2102 return true; 2103 } 2104 2105 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2106 // 2107 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2108 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2109 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2110 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2111 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2112 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2113 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2114 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2115 // 2116 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2117 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2118 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2119 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2120 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2121 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) && 2122 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2123 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2124 ToPointeeType, 2125 ToType, Context); 2126 return true; 2127 } 2128 2129 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2130 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2131 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2132 ToPointeeType, 2133 ToType, Context); 2134 return true; 2135 } 2136 2137 return false; 2138 } 2139 2140 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2141 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2142 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2143 2144 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2145 if (TQs == Qs) 2146 return T; 2147 2148 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2149 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2150 2151 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2152 } 2153 2154 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2155 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2156 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2157 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2158 QualType& ConvertedType, 2159 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2160 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 2161 return false; 2162 2163 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2164 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2165 2166 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2167 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2168 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2169 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2170 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2171 2172 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2173 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2174 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2175 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2176 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2177 return false; 2178 2179 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2180 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2181 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2182 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2183 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2184 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2185 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2186 return false; 2187 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2188 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2189 ToType, Context); 2190 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2191 return true; 2192 } 2193 2194 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2195 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2196 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2197 // complain about it. 2198 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2199 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2200 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2201 ToType, Context); 2202 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2203 return true; 2204 } 2205 } 2206 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2207 QualType ToPointeeType; 2208 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2209 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2210 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2211 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2212 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2213 // to a block pointer type. 2214 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2215 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2216 return true; 2217 } 2218 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2219 } 2220 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2221 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2222 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2223 // pointer to any object. 2224 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2225 return true; 2226 } 2227 else 2228 return false; 2229 2230 QualType FromPointeeType; 2231 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2232 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2233 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2234 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2235 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2236 else 2237 return false; 2238 2239 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2240 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2241 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2242 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2243 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2244 // We always complain about this conversion. 2245 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2246 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2247 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2248 return true; 2249 } 2250 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2251 // as in I* to id. 2252 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2253 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2254 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2255 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2256 2257 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2258 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2259 return true; 2260 } 2261 2262 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2263 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2264 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2265 // complain about it). 2266 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2267 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2268 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2269 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2270 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2271 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2272 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2273 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2274 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2275 return false; 2276 2277 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2278 // function types are obviously different. 2279 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2280 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2281 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 2282 return false; 2283 2284 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2285 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2286 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2287 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2288 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2289 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2290 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2291 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2292 HasObjCConversion = true; 2293 } else { 2294 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2295 return false; 2296 } 2297 2298 // Check argument types. 2299 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2300 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2301 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2302 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2303 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2304 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2305 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2306 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2307 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2308 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2309 HasObjCConversion = true; 2310 } else { 2311 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2312 return false; 2313 } 2314 } 2315 2316 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2317 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2318 // conversion, but complain about it. 2319 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2320 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2321 return true; 2322 } 2323 } 2324 2325 return false; 2326 } 2327 2328 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2329 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2330 /// 2331 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2332 /// 2333 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2334 /// 2335 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2336 /// this conversion. 2337 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2338 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2339 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2340 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2341 return false; 2342 2343 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2344 QualType ToPointee; 2345 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2346 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2347 else 2348 return false; 2349 2350 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2351 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2352 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2353 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2354 return false; 2355 2356 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2357 QualType FromPointee; 2358 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2359 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2360 else 2361 return false; 2362 2363 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2364 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2365 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2366 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2367 return false; 2368 2369 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2370 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2371 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2372 return false; 2373 2374 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2375 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2376 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2377 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2378 2379 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2380 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2381 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2382 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2383 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2384 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2385 IncompatibleObjC)) 2386 return false; 2387 2388 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2389 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2390 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2391 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2392 return true; 2393 } 2394 2395 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2396 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2397 QualType ToPointeeType; 2398 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2399 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2400 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2401 else 2402 return false; 2403 2404 QualType FromPointeeType; 2405 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2406 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2407 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2408 else 2409 return false; 2410 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2411 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2412 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2413 2414 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2415 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2416 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2417 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2418 2419 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2420 return false; 2421 2422 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2423 return true; 2424 2425 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2426 // function types are obviously different. 2427 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2428 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2429 return false; 2430 2431 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2432 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2433 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2434 return false; 2435 2436 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2437 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2438 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2439 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2440 } else { 2441 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2442 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2443 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2444 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2445 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2446 2447 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2448 // OK exact match. 2449 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2450 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2451 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2452 return false; 2453 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2454 } 2455 else 2456 return false; 2457 } 2458 2459 // Check argument types. 2460 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2461 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2462 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2463 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2464 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2465 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2466 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2467 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2468 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2469 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2470 return false; 2471 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2472 } else 2473 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2474 return false; 2475 } 2476 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount && 2477 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType, 2478 ToFunctionType)) 2479 return false; 2480 2481 ConvertedType = ToType; 2482 return true; 2483 } 2484 2485 enum { 2486 ft_default, 2487 ft_different_class, 2488 ft_parameter_arity, 2489 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2490 ft_return_type, 2491 ft_qualifer_mismatch 2492 }; 2493 2494 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2495 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2496 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2497 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2498 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2499 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2500 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2501 PDiag << ft_default; 2502 return; 2503 } 2504 2505 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2506 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2507 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2508 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2509 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2510 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2511 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2512 return; 2513 } 2514 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2515 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2516 } 2517 2518 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2519 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2520 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2521 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2522 2523 // Remove references. 2524 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2525 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2526 2527 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2528 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2529 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2530 PDiag << ft_default; 2531 return; 2532 } 2533 2534 // No extra info for same types. 2535 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2536 PDiag << ft_default; 2537 return; 2538 } 2539 2540 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), 2541 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2542 2543 // Both types need to be function types. 2544 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2545 PDiag << ft_default; 2546 return; 2547 } 2548 2549 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2550 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2551 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2552 return; 2553 } 2554 2555 // Handle different parameter types. 2556 unsigned ArgPos; 2557 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2558 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2559 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2560 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2561 return; 2562 } 2563 2564 // Handle different return type. 2565 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2566 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2567 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2568 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2569 return; 2570 } 2571 2572 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(), 2573 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals(); 2574 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) { 2575 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals; 2576 return; 2577 } 2578 2579 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2580 PDiag << ft_default; 2581 } 2582 2583 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2584 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2585 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2586 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2587 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2588 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2589 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2590 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2591 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2592 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2593 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2594 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(), 2595 N->getUnqualifiedType())) { 2596 if (ArgPos) 2597 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2598 return false; 2599 } 2600 } 2601 return true; 2602 } 2603 2604 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2605 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2606 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2607 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2608 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2609 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2610 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2611 CastKind &Kind, 2612 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2613 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2614 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2615 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2616 2617 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2618 2619 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2620 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2621 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2622 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2623 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 2624 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 2625 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 2626 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 2627 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 2628 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2629 } 2630 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2631 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2632 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 2633 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2634 2635 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2636 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2637 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 2638 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 2639 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, 2640 From->getExprLoc(), 2641 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath, 2642 IgnoreBaseAccess)) 2643 return true; 2644 2645 // The conversion was successful. 2646 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 2647 } 2648 } 2649 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 2650 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2651 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 2652 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2653 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 2654 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 2655 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 2656 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 2657 return false; 2658 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2659 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2660 } else { 2661 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2662 } 2663 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2664 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 2665 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 2666 } 2667 2668 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 2669 // reasons. 2670 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2671 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 2672 2673 return false; 2674 } 2675 2676 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2677 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 2678 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 2679 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 2680 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 2681 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 2682 QualType ToType, 2683 bool InOverloadResolution, 2684 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2685 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2686 if (!ToTypePtr) 2687 return false; 2688 2689 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 2690 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2691 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2692 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 2693 ConvertedType = ToType; 2694 return true; 2695 } 2696 2697 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 2698 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2699 if (!FromTypePtr) 2700 return false; 2701 2702 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 2703 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 2704 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2705 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2706 2707 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 2708 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) && 2709 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) { 2710 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 2711 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 2712 return true; 2713 } 2714 2715 return false; 2716 } 2717 2718 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 2719 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 2720 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 2721 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 2722 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 2723 /// otherwise. 2724 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2725 CastKind &Kind, 2726 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 2727 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2728 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2729 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2730 if (!FromPtrType) { 2731 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 2732 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2733 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 2734 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 2735 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 2736 return false; 2737 } 2738 2739 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2740 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 2741 "that is not a member pointer."); 2742 2743 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2744 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2745 2746 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 2747 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2748 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2749 2750 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 2751 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 2752 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 2753 assert(DerivationOkay && 2754 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 2755 (void)DerivationOkay; 2756 2757 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 2758 getUnqualifiedType())) { 2759 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 2760 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 2761 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 2762 return true; 2763 } 2764 2765 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 2766 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 2767 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 2768 << From->getSourceRange(); 2769 return true; 2770 } 2771 2772 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 2773 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 2774 Paths.front(), 2775 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 2776 2777 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 2778 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 2779 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 2780 return false; 2781 } 2782 2783 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 2784 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 2785 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 2786 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 2787 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 2788 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 2789 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 2790 return false; 2791 2792 return true; 2793 } 2794 2795 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 2796 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 2797 /// (C++ 4.4). 2798 /// 2799 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 2800 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 2801 /// object lifetime. 2802 bool 2803 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2804 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 2805 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 2806 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 2807 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 2808 2809 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 2810 // qualification conversion. 2811 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 2812 return false; 2813 2814 // (C++ 4.4p4): 2815 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 2816 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 2817 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 2818 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 2819 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 2820 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 2821 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 2822 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 2823 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 2824 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 2825 // unwrap. 2826 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 2827 2828 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2829 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 2830 2831 // Objective-C ARC: 2832 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 2833 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() && 2834 UnwrappedAnyPointer) { 2835 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 2836 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 2837 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 2838 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2839 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2840 } else { 2841 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 2842 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 2843 return false; 2844 } 2845 } 2846 2847 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 2848 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 2849 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 2850 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 2851 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 2852 } 2853 2854 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 2855 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 2856 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2857 return false; 2858 2859 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 2860 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 2861 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() 2862 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 2863 return false; 2864 2865 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 2866 // include const. 2867 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 2868 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 2869 } 2870 2871 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 2872 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 2873 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 2874 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 2875 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 2876 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 2877 } 2878 2879 /// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 2880 /// atomic type. 2881 /// 2882 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 2883 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 2884 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2885 bool InOverloadResolution, 2886 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2887 bool CStyle) { 2888 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 2889 if (!ToAtomic) 2890 return false; 2891 2892 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 2893 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 2894 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 2895 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 2896 return false; 2897 2898 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 2899 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 2900 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 2901 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 2902 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 2903 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 2904 return true; 2905 } 2906 2907 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 2908 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 2909 QualType Type) { 2910 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType = 2911 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2912 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 2913 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 2914 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 2915 return true; 2916 } 2917 return false; 2918 } 2919 2920 static OverloadingResult 2921 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2922 CXXRecordDecl *To, 2923 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 2924 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 2925 bool AllowExplicit) { 2926 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To); 2927 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end(); 2928 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 2929 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 2930 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 2931 2932 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 2933 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr; 2934 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 2935 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 2936 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2937 Constructor 2938 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 2939 else 2940 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 2941 2942 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 2943 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) && 2944 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 2945 if (Usable) { 2946 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 2947 // suppress conversions. 2948 bool SuppressUserConversions = 2949 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType); 2950 if (ConstructorTmpl) 2951 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 2952 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, 2953 From, CandidateSet, 2954 SuppressUserConversions); 2955 else 2956 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 2957 From, CandidateSet, 2958 SuppressUserConversions); 2959 } 2960 } 2961 2962 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 2963 2964 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2965 switch (auto Result = 2966 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 2967 Best, true)) { 2968 case OR_Deleted: 2969 case OR_Success: { 2970 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 2971 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 2972 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 2973 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 2974 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2975 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 2976 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 2977 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 2978 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 2979 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 2980 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 2981 return Result; 2982 } 2983 2984 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 2985 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 2986 case OR_Ambiguous: 2987 return OR_Ambiguous; 2988 } 2989 2990 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 2991 } 2992 2993 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 2994 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 2995 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 2996 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 2997 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 2998 /// false and User is unspecified. 2999 /// 3000 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3001 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3002 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3003 /// 3004 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3005 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3006 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3007 static OverloadingResult 3008 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3009 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3010 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3011 bool AllowExplicit, 3012 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3013 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3014 3015 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3016 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3017 3018 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3019 // constructors. 3020 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3021 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3022 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3023 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3024 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3025 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3026 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3027 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3028 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3029 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3030 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3031 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType))) 3032 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3033 3034 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0); 3035 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl 3036 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now 3037 // to try to recover. 3038 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) { 3039 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3040 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3041 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3042 3043 Expr **Args = &From; 3044 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3045 bool ListInitializing = false; 3046 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3047 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3048 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3049 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 3050 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3051 return Result; 3052 // Never mind. 3053 CandidateSet.clear(); 3054 3055 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3056 // arguments, not the entire list. 3057 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3058 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3059 ListInitializing = true; 3060 } 3061 3062 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl); 3063 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end(); 3064 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 3065 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 3066 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 3067 3068 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 3069 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr; 3070 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 3071 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 3072 if (ConstructorTmpl) 3073 Constructor 3074 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 3075 else 3076 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 3077 3078 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3079 if (ListInitializing) 3080 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 3081 else 3082 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit); 3083 if (Usable) { 3084 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3085 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3086 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3087 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3088 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3089 // suppress conversions. 3090 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3091 S.Context, Constructor, ToType); 3092 } 3093 } 3094 if (ConstructorTmpl) 3095 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 3096 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, 3097 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3098 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3099 else 3100 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3101 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3102 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 3103 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3104 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3105 } 3106 } 3107 } 3108 } 3109 3110 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3111 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3112 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) { 3113 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3114 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 3115 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3116 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3117 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3118 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3119 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3120 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3121 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3122 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3123 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3124 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3125 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3126 3127 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3128 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3129 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3130 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3131 else 3132 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3133 3134 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 3135 if (ConvTemplate) 3136 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 3137 ActingContext, From, ToType, 3138 CandidateSet, 3139 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3140 else 3141 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 3142 From, ToType, CandidateSet, 3143 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3144 } 3145 } 3146 } 3147 } 3148 3149 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3150 3151 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3152 switch (auto Result = CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 3153 Best, true)) { 3154 case OR_Success: 3155 case OR_Deleted: 3156 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3157 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3158 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3159 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3160 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3161 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3162 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3163 // the argument of the constructor. 3164 // 3165 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 3166 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3167 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3168 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3169 } else { 3170 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3171 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3172 else { 3173 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3174 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3175 } 3176 } 3177 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3178 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3179 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3180 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3181 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3182 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3183 return Result; 3184 } 3185 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3186 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3187 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3188 // 3189 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3190 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3191 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3192 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3193 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3194 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3195 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3196 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3197 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3198 3199 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3200 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3201 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3202 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3203 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3204 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3205 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3206 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3207 // 13.3.3.1). 3208 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3209 return Result; 3210 } 3211 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3212 3213 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3214 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3215 3216 case OR_Ambiguous: 3217 return OR_Ambiguous; 3218 } 3219 3220 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3221 } 3222 3223 bool 3224 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3225 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3226 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3227 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3228 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3229 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3230 CandidateSet, false, false); 3231 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3232 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3233 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3234 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) { 3235 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 3236 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3237 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3238 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3239 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3240 } else 3241 return false; 3242 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From); 3243 return true; 3244 } 3245 3246 /// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3247 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3248 /// is possible. 3249 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3250 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3251 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3252 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3253 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3254 3255 // Objective-C++: 3256 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3257 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3258 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3259 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3260 // to keep code working. 3261 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3262 if (!Conv1) 3263 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3264 3265 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3266 if (!Conv2) 3267 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3268 3269 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3270 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3271 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3272 if (Block1 != Block2) 3273 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3274 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3275 } 3276 3277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3278 } 3279 3280 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3281 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3282 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3283 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3284 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3285 } 3286 3287 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3288 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3289 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3290 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3291 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, 3292 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3293 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3294 { 3295 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3296 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3297 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3298 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3299 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3300 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3301 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3302 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3303 // 3304 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3305 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3306 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3307 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3308 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3309 3310 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3311 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3312 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3313 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3314 // standard. For example: 3315 // 3316 // int &f(...); // #1 3317 // void f(char*); // #2 3318 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3319 // 3320 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3321 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3322 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3323 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3324 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3325 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3326 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3327 3328 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3329 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3330 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3331 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3332 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3333 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3334 3335 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3336 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3337 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3338 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3339 3340 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3341 // the same kind. 3342 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3343 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3344 3345 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3346 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3347 3348 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3349 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3350 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3351 3352 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3353 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3354 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3355 // if not that, 3356 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3357 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3358 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3359 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3360 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3361 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3362 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3363 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3364 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3365 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3366 } 3367 3368 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3369 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3370 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3371 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 3372 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3373 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3374 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3375 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3376 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3377 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3378 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3379 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3380 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3381 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3382 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 3383 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3384 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3385 else 3386 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3387 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3388 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3389 } 3390 3391 return Result; 3392 } 3393 3394 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 3395 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3396 Qualifiers Quals; 3397 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 3398 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 3399 } 3400 3401 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 3402 } 3403 3404 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3405 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3406 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3407 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3408 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3409 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3410 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3411 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3412 3413 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3414 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3415 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3416 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3417 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3418 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3419 3420 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3421 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3422 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3423 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3424 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3425 else 3426 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3427 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3428 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3429 3430 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3431 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3432 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3433 } 3434 3435 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3436 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3437 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3438 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3439 3440 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3441 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3442 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3443 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3444 3445 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3446 } 3447 3448 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3449 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3450 static bool 3451 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3452 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3453 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3454 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3455 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3456 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3457 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3458 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3459 // reference*. 3460 // 3461 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3462 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3463 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3464 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3465 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3466 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3467 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3468 return false; 3469 3470 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3471 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3472 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3473 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3474 } 3475 3476 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3477 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3478 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3479 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3480 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 3481 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3482 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3483 { 3484 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3485 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3486 3487 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3488 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3489 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3490 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3491 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3492 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3493 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3494 return CK; 3495 3496 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3497 // defined below), or, if not that, 3498 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3499 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3500 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3501 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3502 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3503 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3504 3505 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3506 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3507 // applies: 3508 3509 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3510 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3511 // that is such a conversion. 3512 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3513 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3514 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3515 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3516 3517 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3518 // 3519 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3520 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3521 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3522 // of B* to void*. 3523 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3524 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3525 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3526 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3527 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3528 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3529 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3530 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3531 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3532 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3533 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3534 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3535 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3536 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3537 return DerivedCK; 3538 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3539 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3540 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3541 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3542 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3543 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3544 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3545 3546 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3547 // conversion, if we need to. 3548 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3549 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3550 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3551 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3552 3553 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3554 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3555 3556 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3557 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3558 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3559 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3560 3561 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3562 // other, it is the better one. 3563 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3564 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3565 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 3566 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3567 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 3568 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 3569 FromObjCPtr2); 3570 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 3571 FromObjCPtr1); 3572 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 3573 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3574 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3575 } 3576 } 3577 } 3578 3579 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 3580 // bullet 3). 3581 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 3582 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3583 return QualCK; 3584 3585 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 3586 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 3587 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 3588 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3589 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 3590 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3591 3592 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3593 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 3594 // which the references refer are the same type except for 3595 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 3596 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 3597 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 3598 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3599 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3600 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3601 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3602 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3603 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3604 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3605 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3606 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 3607 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 3608 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 3609 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 3610 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 3611 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3612 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3613 } 3614 3615 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 3616 // type for comparison. 3617 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3618 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3619 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3620 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3621 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 3622 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3623 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 3624 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3625 } 3626 } 3627 3628 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 3629 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 3630 // is between types of the same size. 3631 // For example: 3632 // void f(float); 3633 // void f(int); 3634 // int main { 3635 // long a; 3636 // f(a); 3637 // } 3638 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 3639 // as clang will do in standard mode. 3640 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 3641 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 3642 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 3643 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 3644 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3645 3646 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3647 } 3648 3649 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3650 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3651 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 3652 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3653 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 3654 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3655 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3656 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 3657 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 3658 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 3659 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 3660 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 3661 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 3662 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 3663 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 3664 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3665 3666 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 3667 // conversion (!) 3668 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3669 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3670 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3671 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3672 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3673 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3674 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3675 3676 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 3677 // them. 3678 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 3679 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3680 3681 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 3682 // for comparison. 3683 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3684 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3685 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3686 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3687 3688 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3689 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3690 3691 // Objective-C++ ARC: 3692 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 3693 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 3694 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 3695 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 3696 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3697 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3698 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3699 } 3700 3701 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3702 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3703 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3704 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3705 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3706 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 3707 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 3708 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 3709 // strict subset of qualifiers. 3710 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 3711 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 3712 // about how the sequences rank. 3713 ; 3714 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 3715 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3716 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 3717 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3718 // qualifiers. 3719 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3720 3721 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3722 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 3723 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3724 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 3725 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3726 // qualifiers. 3727 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3728 3729 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3730 } else { 3731 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 3732 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3733 } 3734 3735 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 3736 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 3737 break; 3738 } 3739 3740 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 3741 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 3742 switch (Result) { 3743 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 3744 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3745 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3746 break; 3747 3748 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 3749 break; 3750 3751 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 3752 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3753 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3754 break; 3755 } 3756 3757 return Result; 3758 } 3759 3760 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3761 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3762 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 3763 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 3764 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 3765 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3766 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 3767 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3768 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3769 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3770 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 3771 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3772 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 3773 3774 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3775 // conversion, if we need to. 3776 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3777 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3778 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3779 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3780 3781 // Canonicalize all of the types. 3782 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 3783 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 3784 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 3785 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 3786 3787 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 3788 // 3789 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 3790 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 3791 // 3792 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 3793 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3794 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3795 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 3796 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 3797 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 3798 QualType FromPointee1 3799 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3800 QualType ToPointee1 3801 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3802 QualType FromPointee2 3803 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3804 QualType ToPointee2 3805 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3806 3807 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 3808 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 3809 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 3810 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3811 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 3812 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3813 } 3814 3815 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 3816 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 3817 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3819 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3820 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3821 } 3822 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3823 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 3824 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 3825 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3826 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 3827 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3828 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 3829 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3830 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 3831 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3832 3833 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 3834 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 3835 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 3836 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 3837 // Objective-C pointer types. 3838 bool FromAssignLeft 3839 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 3840 bool FromAssignRight 3841 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 3842 bool ToAssignLeft 3843 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 3844 bool ToAssignRight 3845 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 3846 3847 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 3848 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 3849 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 3850 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 3851 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3852 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 3853 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 3854 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3855 3856 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 3857 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 3858 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 3859 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3860 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 3861 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3862 3863 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 3864 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 3865 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 3866 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 3867 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3868 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 3869 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 3870 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3871 3872 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 3873 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 3874 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 3875 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3876 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 3877 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3878 3879 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 3880 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3881 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 3882 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) 3883 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3884 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3885 3886 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 3887 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 3888 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 3889 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3890 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3891 } 3892 } 3893 3894 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 3895 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 3896 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 3897 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 3898 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 3899 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3900 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 3901 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3902 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 3903 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3904 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 3905 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3906 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 3907 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 3908 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 3909 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 3910 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3911 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3912 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3913 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 3914 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 3915 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 3916 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 3917 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3918 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 3919 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3920 } 3921 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 3922 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 3923 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3924 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3925 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3926 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3927 } 3928 } 3929 3930 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 3931 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 3932 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 3933 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 3934 // reference of type A&, 3935 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3936 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 3937 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2)) 3938 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3939 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1)) 3940 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3941 } 3942 3943 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 3944 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 3945 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 3946 // reference of type A&, 3947 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 3948 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 3949 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1)) 3950 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3951 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2)) 3952 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3953 } 3954 } 3955 3956 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3957 } 3958 3959 /// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 3960 /// C++ class. 3961 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 3962 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 3963 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 3964 3965 return true; 3966 } 3967 3968 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 3969 /// determine whether they are reference-related, 3970 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 3971 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 3972 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 3973 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 3974 /// type being initialized. 3975 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 3976 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 3977 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 3978 bool &DerivedToBase, 3979 bool &ObjCConversion, 3980 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3981 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 3982 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 3983 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 3984 3985 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 3986 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 3987 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3988 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3989 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3990 3991 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 3992 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 3993 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 3994 // T1 is a base class of T2. 3995 DerivedToBase = false; 3996 ObjCConversion = false; 3997 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3998 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3999 // Nothing to do. 4000 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) && 4001 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4002 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4003 DerivedToBase = true; 4004 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4005 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4006 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4007 ObjCConversion = true; 4008 else 4009 return Ref_Incompatible; 4010 4011 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 4012 // least). 4013 4014 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 4015 // for comparison. 4016 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4017 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4018 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4019 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4020 4021 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4022 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 4023 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 4024 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 4025 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 4026 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 4027 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 4028 // 4029 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space 4030 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in 4031 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address 4032 // space 2. 4033 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() && 4034 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) { 4035 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals)) 4036 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 4037 4038 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4039 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4040 } 4041 4042 if (T1Quals == T2Quals) 4043 return Ref_Compatible; 4044 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4045 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification; 4046 else 4047 return Ref_Related; 4048 } 4049 4050 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible 4051 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4052 static bool 4053 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4054 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4055 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4056 bool AllowExplicit) { 4057 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4058 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 4059 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4060 4061 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4062 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4063 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4064 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4065 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4066 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4067 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4068 4069 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4070 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4071 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4072 if (ConvTemplate) 4073 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4074 else 4075 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4076 4077 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 4078 // explicit conversions, skip it. 4079 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 4080 continue; 4081 4082 if (AllowRvalues) { 4083 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4084 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4085 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4086 4087 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4088 // functions that return lvalues. 4089 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4090 const ReferenceType *RefType 4091 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4092 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4093 continue; 4094 } 4095 4096 if (!ConvTemplate && 4097 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4098 DeclLoc, 4099 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 4100 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4101 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 4102 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) == 4103 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4104 continue; 4105 } else { 4106 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4107 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4108 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4109 4110 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4111 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4112 if (!RefType || 4113 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4114 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4115 continue; 4116 } 4117 4118 if (ConvTemplate) 4119 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 4120 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4121 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4122 else 4123 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 4124 DeclType, CandidateSet, 4125 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4126 } 4127 4128 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4129 4130 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4131 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) { 4132 case OR_Success: 4133 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4134 // 4135 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4136 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4137 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4138 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4139 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4140 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4141 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4142 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4143 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4144 return false; 4145 4146 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4147 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4148 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4149 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4150 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4151 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4152 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4153 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4154 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4155 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4156 return true; 4157 4158 case OR_Ambiguous: 4159 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4160 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4161 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4162 if (Cand->Viable) 4163 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 4164 return true; 4165 4166 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4167 case OR_Deleted: 4168 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4169 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4170 return false; 4171 } 4172 4173 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4174 } 4175 4176 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4177 /// initialization. 4178 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4179 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4180 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4181 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4182 bool AllowExplicit) { 4183 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4184 4185 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4186 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4187 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4188 4189 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4190 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4191 4192 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4193 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4194 // type of the resulting function. 4195 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4196 DeclAccessPair Found; 4197 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4198 false, Found)) 4199 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4200 } 4201 4202 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4203 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4204 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4205 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4206 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4207 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4208 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4209 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 4210 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion); 4211 4212 4213 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4214 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4215 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4216 4217 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4218 if (!isRValRef) { 4219 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4220 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4221 // 4222 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4223 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && 4224 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) { 4225 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4226 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4227 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4228 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4229 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4230 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4231 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4232 ICS.setStandard(); 4233 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4234 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4235 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4236 : ICK_Identity; 4237 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4238 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4239 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4240 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4241 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4242 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4243 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4244 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4245 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4246 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false; 4247 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4248 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4249 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4250 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4251 4252 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4253 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4254 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4255 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4256 return ICS; 4257 } 4258 4259 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4260 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4261 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4262 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4263 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4264 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4265 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4266 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4267 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 4268 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4269 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4270 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4271 AllowExplicit)) 4272 return ICS; 4273 } 4274 } 4275 4276 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4277 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4278 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4279 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4280 return ICS; 4281 4282 // -- If the initializer expression 4283 // 4284 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4285 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4286 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification && 4287 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4288 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4289 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4290 ICS.setStandard(); 4291 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4292 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4293 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4294 : ICK_Identity; 4295 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4296 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4297 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4298 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4299 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4300 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4301 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4302 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4303 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4304 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4305 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4306 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = 4307 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4308 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()); 4309 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4310 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4311 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4312 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4313 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4314 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4315 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4316 return ICS; 4317 } 4318 4319 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4320 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4321 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4322 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4323 // "cv3 T3", 4324 // 4325 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4326 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4327 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4328 // class subobject). 4329 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4330 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 4331 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4332 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4333 AllowExplicit)) { 4334 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4335 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4336 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4337 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4338 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4339 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4340 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4341 4342 return ICS; 4343 } 4344 4345 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4346 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4347 return ICS; 4348 4349 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4350 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4351 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4352 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4353 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4354 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4355 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4356 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4357 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4358 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4359 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4360 // initialization fails. 4361 // 4362 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4363 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important. 4364 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4365 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4366 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4367 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4368 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4369 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4370 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4371 return ICS; 4372 } 4373 4374 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4375 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4376 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4377 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4378 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4379 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4380 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4381 return ICS; 4382 4383 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4384 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4385 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4386 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4387 return ICS; 4388 4389 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4390 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4391 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4392 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4393 // underlying type of the reference according to 4394 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4395 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4396 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4397 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4398 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4399 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4400 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4401 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4402 /*CStyle=*/false, 4403 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4404 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4405 4406 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4407 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4408 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4409 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4410 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4411 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4412 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4413 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4414 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4415 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4416 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4417 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4418 4419 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4420 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4421 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4422 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4423 // lvalue. 4424 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4425 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4426 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4427 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4428 // reference to an rvalue! 4429 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4430 return ICS; 4431 } 4432 4433 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4434 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4435 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4436 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4437 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4438 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4439 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4440 } 4441 4442 return ICS; 4443 } 4444 4445 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4446 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4447 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4448 bool InOverloadResolution, 4449 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4450 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4451 4452 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4453 /// initializer list From. 4454 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4455 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4456 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4457 bool InOverloadResolution, 4458 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4459 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4460 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4461 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4462 4463 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4464 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4465 4466 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4467 // initialized from init lists. 4468 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0)) 4469 return Result; 4470 4471 // Per DR1467: 4472 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 4473 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 4474 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 4475 // to the parameter type. 4476 // 4477 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 4478 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 4479 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 4480 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 4481 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4482 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 4483 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 4484 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 4485 S.IsDerivedFrom(InitType, ToType)) 4486 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4487 SuppressUserConversions, 4488 InOverloadResolution, 4489 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4490 } 4491 // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type, 4492 // initializer is a string literal. 4493 if (ToType->isArrayType()) { 4494 InitializedEntity Entity = 4495 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4496 /*Consumed=*/false); 4497 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4498 Result.setStandard(); 4499 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4500 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4501 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4502 return Result; 4503 } 4504 } 4505 } 4506 4507 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 4508 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 4509 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 4510 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 4511 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 4512 // element of the list to X. 4513 // 4514 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 4515 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 4516 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 4517 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 4518 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 4519 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 4520 // 4521 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 4522 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 4523 QualType X; 4524 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 4525 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 4526 else 4527 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 4528 if (!X.isNull()) { 4529 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 4530 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 4531 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4532 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 4533 InOverloadResolution, 4534 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4535 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 4536 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4537 Result = ICS; 4538 break; 4539 } 4540 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 4541 if (Result.isBad() || 4542 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) == 4543 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4544 Result = ICS; 4545 } 4546 4547 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 4548 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 4549 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 4550 Result.setStandard(); 4551 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4552 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4553 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4554 } 4555 4556 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 4557 return Result; 4558 } 4559 4560 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 4561 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 4562 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 4563 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 4564 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 4565 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 4566 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4567 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4568 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 4569 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4570 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4571 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 4572 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4573 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4574 } 4575 4576 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 4577 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 4578 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 4579 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 4580 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4581 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4582 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 4583 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 4584 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 4585 InitializedEntity Entity = 4586 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4587 /*Consumed=*/false); 4588 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4589 Result.setUserDefined(); 4590 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4591 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 4592 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 4593 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 4594 4595 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4596 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 4597 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4598 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 4599 } 4600 return Result; 4601 } 4602 4603 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 4604 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 4605 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 4606 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 4607 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 4608 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 4609 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 4610 4611 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4612 4613 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 4614 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 4615 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4616 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 4617 4618 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4619 4620 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4621 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4622 // type of the resulting function. 4623 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4624 DeclAccessPair Found; 4625 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 4626 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 4627 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4628 } 4629 4630 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4631 bool dummy1 = false; 4632 bool dummy2 = false; 4633 bool dummy3 = false; 4634 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4635 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1, 4636 dummy2, dummy3); 4637 4638 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 4639 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(), 4640 SuppressUserConversions, 4641 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 4642 } 4643 } 4644 4645 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 4646 // initializer list. 4647 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4648 InOverloadResolution, 4649 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4650 if (Result.isFailure()) 4651 return Result; 4652 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 4653 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 4654 4655 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 4656 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 4657 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4658 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 4659 Result.UserDefined.After; 4660 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 4661 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 4662 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 4663 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4664 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4665 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4666 } else 4667 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 4668 From, ToType); 4669 return Result; 4670 } 4671 4672 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 4673 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 4674 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 4675 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 4676 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 4677 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 4678 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 4679 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 4680 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 4681 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4682 SuppressUserConversions, 4683 InOverloadResolution, 4684 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4685 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 4686 // sequence is the identity conversion. 4687 else if (NumInits == 0) { 4688 Result.setStandard(); 4689 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4690 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4691 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4692 } 4693 return Result; 4694 } 4695 4696 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 4697 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 4698 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 4699 return Result; 4700 } 4701 4702 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 4703 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 4704 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 4705 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 4706 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 4707 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 4708 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4709 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4710 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4711 bool InOverloadResolution, 4712 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4713 bool AllowExplicit) { 4714 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 4715 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4716 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4717 4718 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 4719 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 4720 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 4721 SuppressUserConversions, 4722 AllowExplicit); 4723 4724 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 4725 SuppressUserConversions, 4726 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4727 InOverloadResolution, 4728 /*CStyle=*/false, 4729 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4730 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4731 } 4732 4733 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 4734 const CanQualType ToQTy, 4735 Sema &S, 4736 SourceLocation Loc, 4737 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 4738 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 4739 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4740 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 4741 4742 return !ICS.isBad(); 4743 } 4744 4745 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 4746 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 4747 /// expression @p From. 4748 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4749 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 4750 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 4751 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 4752 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 4753 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 4754 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 4755 // const volatile object. 4756 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 4757 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 4758 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 4759 4760 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 4761 // to exit early. 4762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4763 4764 // We need to have an object of class type. 4765 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4766 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 4767 4768 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 4769 // better have an lvalue. 4770 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 4771 } 4772 4773 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 4774 4775 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 4776 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 4777 // parameter is 4778 // 4779 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 4780 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 4781 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 4782 // ref-qualifier 4783 // 4784 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 4785 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 4786 // 4787 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 4788 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions 4789 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 4790 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 4791 // non-constant references. 4792 4793 // First check the qualifiers. 4794 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 4795 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 4796 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 4797 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 4798 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 4799 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 4800 return ICS; 4801 } 4802 4803 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 4804 // affects the conversion rank. 4805 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 4806 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 4807 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 4808 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 4809 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType)) 4810 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 4811 else { 4812 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 4813 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 4814 return ICS; 4815 } 4816 4817 // Check the ref-qualifier. 4818 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 4819 case RQ_None: 4820 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 4821 break; 4822 4823 case RQ_LValue: 4824 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) { 4825 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 4826 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 4827 ImplicitParamType); 4828 return ICS; 4829 } 4830 break; 4831 4832 case RQ_RValue: 4833 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 4834 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 4835 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 4836 ImplicitParamType); 4837 return ICS; 4838 } 4839 break; 4840 } 4841 4842 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 4843 ICS.setStandard(); 4844 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4845 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 4846 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 4847 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 4848 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4849 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4850 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 4851 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4852 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 4853 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 4854 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 4855 return ICS; 4856 } 4857 4858 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 4859 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 4860 /// expression. 4861 ExprResult 4862 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 4863 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 4864 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 4865 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 4866 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 4867 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 4868 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4869 4870 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 4871 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4872 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 4873 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 4874 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 4875 } else { 4876 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 4877 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 4878 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 4879 } 4880 4881 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 4882 // the actual argument initialization. 4883 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 4884 *this, From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, Method->getParent()); 4885 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4886 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) { 4887 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 4888 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 4889 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 4890 if (CVR) { 4891 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4892 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 4893 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 4894 << From->getSourceRange(); 4895 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 4896 << Method->getDeclName(); 4897 return ExprError(); 4898 } 4899 } 4900 4901 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4902 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init) 4903 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 4904 } 4905 4906 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4907 ExprResult FromRes = 4908 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 4909 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 4910 return ExprError(); 4911 From = FromRes.get(); 4912 } 4913 4914 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 4915 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 4916 From->getValueKind()).get(); 4917 return From; 4918 } 4919 4920 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 4921 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 4922 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4923 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 4924 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 4925 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 4926 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 4927 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4928 /*CStyle=*/false, 4929 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4930 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4931 } 4932 4933 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 4934 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 4935 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 4936 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 4937 return ExprError(); 4938 4939 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 4940 if (!ICS.isBad()) 4941 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 4942 4943 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 4944 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 4945 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 4946 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 4947 return ExprError(); 4948 } 4949 4950 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 4951 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 4952 /// is acceptable. 4953 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 4954 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 4955 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 4956 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 4957 // conversions are fine. 4958 switch (SCS.Second) { 4959 case ICK_Identity: 4960 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment: 4961 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 4962 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 4963 return true; 4964 4965 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 4966 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 4967 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 4968 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 4969 // 4970 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 4971 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 4972 // (non-conforming) extension. 4973 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 4974 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 4975 4976 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 4977 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 4978 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 4979 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 4980 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 4981 4982 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 4983 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 4984 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 4985 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 4986 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 4987 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 4988 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 4989 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 4990 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 4991 case ICK_Complex_Real: 4992 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 4993 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 4994 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 4995 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 4996 return false; 4997 4998 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 4999 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5000 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5001 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5002 5003 case ICK_Qualification: 5004 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5005 5006 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5007 break; 5008 } 5009 5010 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5011 } 5012 5013 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5014 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5015 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5016 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5017 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5018 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5019 bool RequireInt) { 5020 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5021 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5022 5023 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5024 return ExprError(); 5025 5026 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5027 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5028 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5029 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5030 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5031 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5032 TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5033 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5034 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5035 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false, 5036 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5037 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5038 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5039 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5040 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5041 break; 5042 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5043 // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence 5044 // must be trivial. 5045 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5046 break; 5047 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5048 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5049 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5050 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5051 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5052 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5053 return ExprError(); 5054 5055 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5056 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5057 } 5058 5059 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5060 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5061 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5062 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5063 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5064 } 5065 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5066 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5067 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5068 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5069 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5070 } 5071 5072 ExprResult Result = 5073 S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5074 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5075 return Result; 5076 5077 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5078 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5079 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5080 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5081 PreNarrowingType)) { 5082 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5083 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5084 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5085 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5086 break; 5087 5088 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5089 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5090 << CCE << /*Constant*/1 5091 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5092 break; 5093 5094 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5095 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5096 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T; 5097 break; 5098 } 5099 5100 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5101 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5102 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5103 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5104 5105 if ((T->isReferenceType() 5106 ? !Result.get()->EvaluateAsLValue(Eval, S.Context) 5107 : !Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, S.Context)) || 5108 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5109 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5110 // the AST. 5111 Result = ExprError(); 5112 } else { 5113 Value = Eval.Val; 5114 5115 if (Notes.empty()) { 5116 // It's a constant expression. 5117 return Result; 5118 } 5119 } 5120 5121 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5122 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5123 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 5124 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5125 else { 5126 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5127 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5128 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5129 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5130 } 5131 return ExprError(); 5132 } 5133 5134 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5135 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) { 5136 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false); 5137 } 5138 5139 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5140 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5141 CCEKind CCE) { 5142 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5143 5144 APValue V; 5145 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true); 5146 if (!R.isInvalid()) 5147 Value = V.getInt(); 5148 return R; 5149 } 5150 5151 5152 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5153 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5154 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5155 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5156 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5157 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5158 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5159 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5160 } 5161 } 5162 5163 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5164 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5165 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5166 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5167 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5168 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5169 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5170 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5171 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5172 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5173 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5174 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5175 /*CStyle=*/false, 5176 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5177 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5178 5179 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5180 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5181 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5182 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5183 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5184 break; 5185 5186 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5187 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5188 break; 5189 5190 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5191 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5192 break; 5193 } 5194 5195 return ICS; 5196 } 5197 5198 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5199 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5200 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5201 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5202 return ExprError(); 5203 5204 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5205 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5206 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5207 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5208 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5209 return ExprError(); 5210 } 5211 5212 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5213 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5214 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5215 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5216 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5217 } 5218 5219 static ExprResult 5220 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5221 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5222 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5223 5224 if (Converter.Suppress) 5225 return ExprError(); 5226 5227 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5228 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5229 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5230 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5231 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5232 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5233 } 5234 return From; 5235 } 5236 5237 static bool 5238 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5239 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5240 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5241 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5242 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5243 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5244 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5245 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5246 5247 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5248 // conversion; use it. 5249 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5250 std::string TypeStr; 5251 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5252 5253 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5254 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 5255 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5256 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5257 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")"); 5258 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5259 5260 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5261 // explicit conversion function. 5262 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5263 return true; 5264 5265 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5266 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5267 HadMultipleCandidates); 5268 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5269 return true; 5270 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5271 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5272 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5273 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5274 } 5275 return false; 5276 } 5277 5278 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5279 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5280 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5281 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5282 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5283 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5284 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5285 5286 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5287 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5288 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5289 return true; 5290 5291 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5292 << From->getSourceRange(); 5293 } 5294 5295 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5296 HadMultipleCandidates); 5297 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5298 return true; 5299 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5300 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5301 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5302 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5303 return false; 5304 } 5305 5306 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5307 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5308 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5309 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5310 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5311 << From->getSourceRange(); 5312 5313 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5314 } 5315 5316 static void 5317 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5318 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5319 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5320 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5321 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5322 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5323 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5324 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5325 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5326 5327 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5328 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5329 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5330 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5331 else 5332 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5333 5334 if (ConvTemplate) 5335 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 5336 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 5337 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5338 else 5339 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 5340 ToType, CandidateSet, 5341 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5342 } 5343 } 5344 5345 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 5346 /// by the given converter. 5347 /// 5348 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 5349 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 5350 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 5351 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 5352 /// one target type. 5353 /// 5354 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 5355 /// conversion. 5356 /// 5357 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 5358 /// 5359 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 5360 /// 5361 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 5362 /// successful. 5363 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 5364 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5365 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 5366 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 5367 return From; 5368 5369 // Process placeholders immediately. 5370 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 5371 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 5372 if (result.isInvalid()) 5373 return result; 5374 From = result.get(); 5375 } 5376 5377 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 5378 QualType T = From->getType(); 5379 if (Converter.match(T)) 5380 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5381 5382 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 5383 5384 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 5385 // type. 5386 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 5387 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5388 if (!Converter.Suppress) 5389 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5390 return From; 5391 } 5392 5393 // We must have a complete class type. 5394 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 5395 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 5396 Expr *From; 5397 5398 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 5399 : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 5400 5401 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 5402 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5403 } 5404 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 5405 5406 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 5407 return From; 5408 5409 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 5410 UnresolvedSet<4> 5411 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 5412 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 5413 const auto &Conversions = 5414 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 5415 5416 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 5417 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 5418 5419 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 5420 QualType ToType; 5421 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 5422 5423 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 5424 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5425 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5426 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 5427 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5428 if (ConvTemplate) { 5429 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 5430 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5431 else 5432 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 5433 } else 5434 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5435 5436 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 5437 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 5438 "viable in C++1y"); 5439 5440 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5441 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 5442 5443 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 5444 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 5445 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 5446 if (!ConvTemplate) 5447 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5448 } else { 5449 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5450 if (ToType.isNull()) 5451 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 5452 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 5453 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 5454 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 5455 } 5456 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5457 } 5458 } 5459 } 5460 5461 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5462 // C++1y [conv]p6: 5463 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 5464 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 5465 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 5466 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 5467 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 5468 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 5469 // exactly one such T. 5470 5471 // If no unique T is found: 5472 if (ToType.isNull()) { 5473 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5474 HadMultipleCandidates, 5475 ExplicitConversions)) 5476 return ExprError(); 5477 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5478 } 5479 5480 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 5481 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 5482 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5483 ViableConversions); 5484 5485 // If one unique T is found: 5486 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 5487 // potentially viable conversions. 5488 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 5489 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 5490 CandidateSet); 5491 5492 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 5493 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 5494 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 5495 case OR_Success: { 5496 // Apply this conversion. 5497 DeclAccessPair Found = 5498 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 5499 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5500 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5501 return ExprError(); 5502 break; 5503 } 5504 case OR_Ambiguous: 5505 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5506 ViableConversions); 5507 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 5508 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5509 HadMultipleCandidates, 5510 ExplicitConversions)) 5511 return ExprError(); 5512 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case. 5513 case OR_Deleted: 5514 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5515 break; 5516 } 5517 } else { 5518 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 5519 case 0: { 5520 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5521 HadMultipleCandidates, 5522 ExplicitConversions)) 5523 return ExprError(); 5524 5525 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5526 break; 5527 } 5528 case 1: { 5529 // Apply this conversion. 5530 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 5531 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5532 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5533 return ExprError(); 5534 break; 5535 } 5536 default: 5537 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5538 ViableConversions); 5539 } 5540 } 5541 5542 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5543 } 5544 5545 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 5546 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 5547 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 5548 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 5549 /// enumeration types. 5550 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 5551 FunctionDecl *Fn, 5552 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 5553 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 5554 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 5555 5556 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 5557 return true; 5558 5559 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 5560 return true; 5561 5562 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5563 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 5564 return false; 5565 5566 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 5567 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 5568 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 5569 return true; 5570 } 5571 5572 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 5573 return false; 5574 5575 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 5576 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 5577 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 5578 return true; 5579 } 5580 5581 return false; 5582 } 5583 5584 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 5585 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 5586 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 5587 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 5588 /// 5589 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 5590 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 5591 /// code completion. 5592 void 5593 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 5594 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5595 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5596 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 5597 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5598 bool PartialOverloading, 5599 bool AllowExplicit) { 5600 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 5601 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 5602 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 5603 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 5604 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 5605 5606 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 5607 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 5608 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 5609 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 5610 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 5611 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 5612 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 5613 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 5614 // is irrelevant. 5615 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), 5616 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), 5617 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 5618 PartialOverloading); 5619 return; 5620 } 5621 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 5622 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 5623 } 5624 5625 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 5626 return; 5627 5628 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 5629 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 5630 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 5631 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 5632 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 5633 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 5634 // candidate functions. 5635 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 5636 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 5637 return; 5638 5639 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 5640 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 5641 // overload resolution. 5642 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 5643 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 5644 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 5645 return; 5646 5647 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5648 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 5649 5650 // Add this candidate 5651 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 5652 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5653 Candidate.Function = Function; 5654 Candidate.Viable = true; 5655 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5656 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5657 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5658 5659 if (Constructor) { 5660 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 5661 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 5662 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 5663 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 5664 if (Args.size() == 1 && 5665 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 5666 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 5667 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType))) { 5668 Candidate.Viable = false; 5669 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 5670 return; 5671 } 5672 } 5673 5674 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5675 5676 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 5677 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 5678 // list (8.3.5). 5679 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 5680 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 5681 Candidate.Viable = false; 5682 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 5683 return; 5684 } 5685 5686 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 5687 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 5688 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 5689 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 5690 // exactly m parameters. 5691 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 5692 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 5693 // Not enough arguments. 5694 Candidate.Viable = false; 5695 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 5696 return; 5697 } 5698 5699 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 5700 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 5701 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 5702 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 5703 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 5704 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 5705 // the class. 5706 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) { 5707 Candidate.Viable = false; 5708 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 5709 return; 5710 } 5711 5712 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5713 // arguments. 5714 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 5715 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 5716 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 5717 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 5718 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 5719 // parameter of F. 5720 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 5721 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 5722 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 5723 SuppressUserConversions, 5724 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 5725 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5726 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 5727 AllowExplicit); 5728 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 5729 Candidate.Viable = false; 5730 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 5731 return; 5732 } 5733 } else { 5734 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 5735 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 5736 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 5737 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 5738 } 5739 } 5740 5741 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) { 5742 Candidate.Viable = false; 5743 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 5744 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 5745 return; 5746 } 5747 } 5748 5749 ObjCMethodDecl *Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, 5750 bool IsInstance) { 5751 SmallVector<ObjCMethodDecl*, 4> Methods; 5752 if (!CollectMultipleMethodsInGlobalPool(Sel, Methods, IsInstance)) 5753 return nullptr; 5754 5755 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 5756 bool Match = true; 5757 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 5758 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 5759 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 5760 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 5761 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 5762 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 5763 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 5764 continue; 5765 5766 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 5767 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 5768 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 5769 Match = false; 5770 break; 5771 } 5772 5773 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 5774 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 5775 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 5776 5777 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 5778 // a consumed argument. 5779 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 5780 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 5781 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 5782 5783 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 5784 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5785 Match = false; 5786 break; 5787 } 5788 5789 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 5790 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 5791 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 5792 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 5793 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 5794 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 5795 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 5796 if (ConversionState.isBad()) { 5797 Match = false; 5798 break; 5799 } 5800 } 5801 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 5802 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 5803 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 5804 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 5805 Match = false; 5806 break; 5807 } 5808 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 5809 nullptr); 5810 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 5811 Match = false; 5812 break; 5813 } 5814 } 5815 } else { 5816 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 5817 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 5818 Match = false; 5819 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 5820 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 5821 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 5822 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 5823 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 5824 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 5825 return Methods[b]; 5826 } 5827 } 5828 } 5829 5830 if (Match) 5831 return Method; 5832 } 5833 return nullptr; 5834 } 5835 5836 static bool IsNotEnableIfAttr(Attr *A) { return !isa<EnableIfAttr>(A); } 5837 5838 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5839 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 5840 // FIXME: specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> iterates in reverse order, but 5841 // we need to find the first failing one. 5842 if (!Function->hasAttrs()) 5843 return nullptr; 5844 AttrVec Attrs = Function->getAttrs(); 5845 AttrVec::iterator E = std::remove_if(Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 5846 IsNotEnableIfAttr); 5847 if (Attrs.begin() == E) 5848 return nullptr; 5849 std::reverse(Attrs.begin(), E); 5850 5851 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 5852 5853 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 5854 bool InitializationFailed = false; 5855 bool ContainsValueDependentExpr = false; 5856 5857 // Convert the arguments. 5858 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 5859 if (i == 0 && !MissingImplicitThis && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Function) && 5860 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)->isStatic() && 5861 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)) { 5862 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 5863 ExprResult R = 5864 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 5865 Method, Method); 5866 if (R.isInvalid()) { 5867 InitializationFailed = true; 5868 break; 5869 } 5870 ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent(); 5871 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 5872 } else { 5873 ExprResult R = 5874 PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5875 Context, 5876 Function->getParamDecl(i)), 5877 SourceLocation(), 5878 Args[i]); 5879 if (R.isInvalid()) { 5880 InitializationFailed = true; 5881 break; 5882 } 5883 ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent(); 5884 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 5885 } 5886 } 5887 5888 if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 5889 return cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attrs[0]); 5890 5891 // Push default arguments if needed. 5892 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 5893 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 5894 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 5895 ExprResult R = PerformCopyInitialization( 5896 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 5897 Function->getParamDecl(i)), 5898 SourceLocation(), 5899 P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg() ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 5900 : P->getDefaultArg()); 5901 if (R.isInvalid()) { 5902 InitializationFailed = true; 5903 break; 5904 } 5905 ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent(); 5906 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 5907 } 5908 5909 if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 5910 return cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attrs[0]); 5911 } 5912 5913 for (AttrVec::iterator I = Attrs.begin(); I != E; ++I) { 5914 APValue Result; 5915 EnableIfAttr *EIA = cast<EnableIfAttr>(*I); 5916 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent()) { 5917 // Don't even try now, we'll examine it after instantiation. 5918 continue; 5919 } 5920 5921 if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 5922 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) { 5923 if (!ContainsValueDependentExpr) 5924 return EIA; 5925 } else if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) { 5926 return EIA; 5927 } 5928 } 5929 return nullptr; 5930 } 5931 5932 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 5933 /// the overload candidate set. 5934 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 5935 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5936 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5937 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5938 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5939 bool PartialOverloading) { 5940 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 5941 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5942 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 5943 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) 5944 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 5945 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), 5946 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context), 5947 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet, 5948 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 5949 else 5950 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet, 5951 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 5952 } else { 5953 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5954 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) && 5955 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic()) 5956 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 5957 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 5958 ExplicitTemplateArgs, 5959 Args[0]->getType(), 5960 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 5961 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 5962 PartialOverloading); 5963 else 5964 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 5965 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 5966 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 5967 PartialOverloading); 5968 } 5969 } 5970 } 5971 5972 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 5973 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 5974 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5975 QualType ObjectType, 5976 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 5977 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5978 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 5979 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 5980 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5981 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 5982 5983 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 5984 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 5985 5986 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 5987 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 5988 "Expected a member function template"); 5989 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 5990 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, 5991 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 5992 Args, CandidateSet, 5993 SuppressUserConversions); 5994 } else { 5995 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 5996 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 5997 Args, 5998 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 5999 } 6000 } 6001 6002 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6003 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6004 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6005 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6006 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6007 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6008 /// operators. 6009 void 6010 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6011 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6012 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6013 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6014 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6015 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6016 bool PartialOverloading) { 6017 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6018 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6019 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6020 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6021 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6022 6023 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 6024 return; 6025 6026 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6027 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6028 // ignored by overload resolution. 6029 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6030 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6031 return; 6032 6033 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6034 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 6035 6036 // Add this candidate 6037 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 6038 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6039 Candidate.Function = Method; 6040 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6041 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6042 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6043 6044 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6045 6046 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6047 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6048 // list (8.3.5). 6049 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6050 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6051 Candidate.Viable = false; 6052 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6053 return; 6054 } 6055 6056 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6057 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6058 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6059 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6060 // exactly m parameters. 6061 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6062 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6063 // Not enough arguments. 6064 Candidate.Viable = false; 6065 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6066 return; 6067 } 6068 6069 Candidate.Viable = true; 6070 6071 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6072 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6073 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6074 else { 6075 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6076 // parameter. 6077 Candidate.Conversions[0] 6078 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6079 Method, ActingContext); 6080 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6081 Candidate.Viable = false; 6082 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6083 return; 6084 } 6085 } 6086 6087 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6088 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6089 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6090 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Method)) { 6091 Candidate.Viable = false; 6092 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6093 return; 6094 } 6095 6096 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6097 // arguments. 6098 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6099 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6100 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6101 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6102 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6103 // parameter of F. 6104 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6105 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 6106 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6107 SuppressUserConversions, 6108 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6109 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6110 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6111 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 6112 Candidate.Viable = false; 6113 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6114 return; 6115 } 6116 } else { 6117 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6118 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6119 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6120 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 6121 } 6122 } 6123 6124 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 6125 Candidate.Viable = false; 6126 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6127 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6128 return; 6129 } 6130 } 6131 6132 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 6133 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 6134 /// function template specialization. 6135 void 6136 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 6137 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6138 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6139 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6140 QualType ObjectType, 6141 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6142 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6143 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6144 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6145 bool PartialOverloading) { 6146 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 6147 return; 6148 6149 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6150 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6151 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6152 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6153 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6154 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6155 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6156 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6157 // functions. 6158 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6159 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6160 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6161 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 6162 Specialization, Info, PartialOverloading)) { 6163 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 6164 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6165 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 6166 Candidate.Viable = false; 6167 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6168 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6169 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6170 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6171 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6172 Info); 6173 return; 6174 } 6175 6176 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6177 // deduction as a candidate. 6178 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 6179 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 6180 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 6181 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 6182 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 6183 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6184 } 6185 6186 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 6187 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 6188 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 6189 void 6190 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 6191 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6192 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6193 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6194 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6195 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6196 bool PartialOverloading) { 6197 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 6198 return; 6199 6200 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6201 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6202 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6203 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6204 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6205 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6206 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6207 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6208 // functions. 6209 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6210 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6211 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6212 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 6213 Specialization, Info, PartialOverloading)) { 6214 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 6215 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6216 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6217 Candidate.Viable = false; 6218 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6219 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6220 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6221 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6222 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6223 Info); 6224 return; 6225 } 6226 6227 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6228 // deduction as a candidate. 6229 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 6230 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 6231 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6232 } 6233 6234 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 6235 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 6236 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 6237 /// 6238 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 6239 /// 6240 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 6241 /// 6242 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 6243 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 6244 /// 6245 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 6246 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 6247 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 6248 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 6249 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 6250 6251 // Easy case: the types are the same. 6252 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 6253 return true; 6254 6255 // Allow qualification conversions. 6256 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 6257 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 6258 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 6259 return true; 6260 6261 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 6262 // we're done. 6263 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 6264 return false; 6265 6266 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 6267 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 6268 QualType ConvertedType; 6269 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 6270 IncompatibleObjC); 6271 } 6272 6273 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 6274 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 6275 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 6276 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 6277 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 6278 /// conversion function produces). 6279 void 6280 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 6281 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6282 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6283 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6284 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6285 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 6286 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6287 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 6288 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6289 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 6290 return; 6291 6292 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 6293 // deduction now. 6294 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 6295 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 6296 return; 6297 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6298 } 6299 6300 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 6301 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 6302 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 6303 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 6304 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 6305 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 6306 return; 6307 6308 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6309 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 6310 6311 // Add this candidate 6312 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 6313 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6314 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 6315 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6316 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6317 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 6318 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 6319 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 6320 Candidate.Viable = true; 6321 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 6322 6323 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 6324 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 6325 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 6326 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 6327 // 6328 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 6329 // object parameter. 6330 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 6331 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6332 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 6333 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 6334 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 6335 6336 Candidate.Conversions[0] 6337 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), 6338 From->Classify(Context), 6339 Conversion, ConversionContext); 6340 6341 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6342 Candidate.Viable = false; 6343 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6344 return; 6345 } 6346 6347 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 6348 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 6349 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 6350 QualType FromCanon 6351 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 6352 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6353 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 6354 Candidate.Viable = false; 6355 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 6356 return; 6357 } 6358 6359 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 6360 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 6361 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 6362 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 6363 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 6364 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 6365 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 6366 // well-formed. 6367 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 6368 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 6369 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 6370 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 6371 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 6372 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 6373 6374 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 6375 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) { 6376 Candidate.Viable = false; 6377 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6378 return; 6379 } 6380 6381 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 6382 6383 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 6384 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 6385 // allocator). 6386 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 6387 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK, 6388 From->getLocStart()); 6389 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 6390 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 6391 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 6392 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6393 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 6394 6395 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 6396 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 6397 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 6398 6399 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 6400 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 6401 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 6402 // shall have exact match rank. 6403 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 6404 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 6405 Candidate.Viable = false; 6406 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 6407 return; 6408 } 6409 6410 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 6411 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 6412 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 6413 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 6414 // program is ill-formed. 6415 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 6416 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 6417 Candidate.Viable = false; 6418 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6419 return; 6420 } 6421 break; 6422 6423 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 6424 Candidate.Viable = false; 6425 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6426 return; 6427 6428 default: 6429 llvm_unreachable( 6430 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 6431 } 6432 6433 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 6434 Candidate.Viable = false; 6435 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6436 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6437 return; 6438 } 6439 } 6440 6441 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization 6442 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 6443 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 6444 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 6445 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 6446 void 6447 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 6448 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6449 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 6450 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6451 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6452 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 6453 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6454 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 6455 6456 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 6457 return; 6458 6459 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6460 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6461 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6462 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 6463 Specialization, Info)) { 6464 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 6465 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6466 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6467 Candidate.Viable = false; 6468 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6469 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6470 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6471 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 6472 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6473 Info); 6474 return; 6475 } 6476 6477 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 6478 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 6479 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 6480 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 6481 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 6482 } 6483 6484 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 6485 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 6486 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 6487 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 6488 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 6489 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 6490 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6491 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6492 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 6493 Expr *Object, 6494 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6495 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 6496 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 6497 return; 6498 6499 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6500 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 6501 6502 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 6503 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6504 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 6505 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 6506 Candidate.Viable = true; 6507 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 6508 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6509 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6510 6511 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 6512 // object parameter. 6513 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit 6514 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(), 6515 Object->Classify(Context), 6516 Conversion, ActingContext); 6517 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 6518 Candidate.Viable = false; 6519 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6520 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 6521 return; 6522 } 6523 6524 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 6525 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 6526 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 6527 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 6528 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 6529 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 6530 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 6531 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 6532 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 6533 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 6534 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 6535 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 6536 6537 // Find the 6538 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6539 6540 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6541 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6542 // list (8.3.5). 6543 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6544 Candidate.Viable = false; 6545 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6546 return; 6547 } 6548 6549 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 6550 // we have enough arguments. 6551 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 6552 // Not enough arguments. 6553 Candidate.Viable = false; 6554 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6555 return; 6556 } 6557 6558 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6559 // arguments. 6560 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 6561 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6562 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6563 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6564 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6565 // parameter of F. 6566 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6567 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 6568 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6569 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 6570 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6571 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6572 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6573 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 6574 Candidate.Viable = false; 6575 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6576 return; 6577 } 6578 } else { 6579 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6580 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6581 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6582 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 6583 } 6584 } 6585 6586 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 6587 Candidate.Viable = false; 6588 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6589 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6590 return; 6591 } 6592 } 6593 6594 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 6595 /// member functions. 6596 /// 6597 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 6598 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 6599 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 6600 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 6601 /// [over.match.oper]). 6602 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 6603 SourceLocation OpLoc, 6604 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6605 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6606 SourceRange OpRange) { 6607 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 6608 6609 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6610 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 6611 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 6612 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 6613 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 6614 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 6615 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 6616 // constructed as follows: 6617 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6618 6619 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 6620 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 6621 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 6622 // the set of member candidates is empty. 6623 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 6624 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 6625 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0); 6626 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 6627 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 6628 return; 6629 6630 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 6631 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 6632 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 6633 6634 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 6635 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 6636 Oper != OperEnd; 6637 ++Oper) 6638 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 6639 Args[0]->Classify(Context), 6640 Args.slice(1), 6641 CandidateSet, 6642 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false); 6643 } 6644 } 6645 6646 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 6647 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 6648 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 6649 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 6650 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 6651 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 6652 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 6653 /// converted to bool. 6654 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys, 6655 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6656 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6657 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 6658 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 6659 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6660 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 6661 6662 // Add this candidate 6663 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 6664 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 6665 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 6666 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6667 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6668 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy; 6669 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 6670 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx]; 6671 6672 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6673 // arguments. 6674 Candidate.Viable = true; 6675 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6676 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 6677 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 6678 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 6679 // left operand are restricted as follows: 6680 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 6681 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 6682 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 6683 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 6684 // 6685 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 6686 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 6687 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 6688 // is not of the same type. 6689 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 6690 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 6691 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 6692 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 6693 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 6694 } else { 6695 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 6696 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 6697 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 6698 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6699 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6700 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6701 } 6702 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 6703 Candidate.Viable = false; 6704 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6705 break; 6706 } 6707 } 6708 } 6709 6710 namespace { 6711 6712 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 6713 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 6714 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 6715 /// enumeration types. 6716 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 6717 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 6718 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet; 6719 6720 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 6721 /// built-in candidates. 6722 TypeSet PointerTypes; 6723 6724 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 6725 /// used in the built-in candidates. 6726 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 6727 6728 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 6729 /// used in the built-in candidates. 6730 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 6731 6732 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 6733 /// candidates. 6734 TypeSet VectorTypes; 6735 6736 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 6737 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 6738 6739 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 6740 /// were present in the candidate set. 6741 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 6742 6743 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 6744 /// candidate set. 6745 bool HasNullPtrType; 6746 6747 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 6748 /// candidate type set. 6749 Sema &SemaRef; 6750 6751 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 6752 ASTContext &Context; 6753 6754 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 6755 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 6756 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 6757 6758 public: 6759 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 6760 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 6761 6762 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 6763 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 6764 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 6765 HasNullPtrType(false), 6766 SemaRef(SemaRef), 6767 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 6768 6769 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 6770 SourceLocation Loc, 6771 bool AllowUserConversions, 6772 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6773 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 6774 6775 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 6776 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 6777 6778 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 6779 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 6780 6781 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 6782 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 6783 6784 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 6785 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 6786 6787 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 6788 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 6789 6790 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 6791 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 6792 6793 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 6794 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 6795 6796 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 6797 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 6798 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 6799 }; 6800 6801 } // end anonymous namespace 6802 6803 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 6804 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 6805 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 6806 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 6807 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 6808 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 6809 /// false otherwise. 6810 /// 6811 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 6812 bool 6813 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 6814 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 6815 6816 // Insert this type. 6817 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty).second) 6818 return false; 6819 6820 QualType PointeeTy; 6821 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 6822 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 6823 if (!PointerTy) { 6824 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6825 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6826 buildObjCPtr = true; 6827 } else { 6828 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 6829 } 6830 6831 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 6832 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 6833 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 6834 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 6835 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 6836 return true; 6837 6838 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 6839 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 6840 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 6841 6842 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 6843 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 6844 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 6845 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 6846 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 6847 6848 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 6849 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 6850 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 6851 (!hasRestrict || 6852 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 6853 continue; 6854 6855 // Build qualified pointee type. 6856 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 6857 6858 // Build qualified pointer type. 6859 QualType QPointerTy; 6860 if (!buildObjCPtr) 6861 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 6862 else 6863 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 6864 6865 // Insert qualified pointer type. 6866 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 6867 } 6868 6869 return true; 6870 } 6871 6872 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 6873 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 6874 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 6875 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 6876 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 6877 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 6878 /// false otherwise. 6879 /// 6880 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 6881 bool 6882 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 6883 QualType Ty) { 6884 // Insert this type. 6885 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty).second) 6886 return false; 6887 6888 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 6889 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 6890 6891 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 6892 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 6893 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 6894 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 6895 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 6896 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 6897 return true; 6898 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 6899 6900 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 6901 // qualifiers. 6902 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 6903 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 6904 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 6905 6906 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 6907 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 6908 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 6909 } 6910 6911 return true; 6912 } 6913 6914 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 6915 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 6916 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 6917 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 6918 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 6919 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 6920 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 6921 /// type. 6922 void 6923 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 6924 SourceLocation Loc, 6925 bool AllowUserConversions, 6926 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6927 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 6928 // Only deal with canonical types. 6929 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 6930 6931 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 6932 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 6933 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 6934 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 6935 6936 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 6937 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 6938 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 6939 6940 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 6941 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 6942 6943 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 6944 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6945 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 6946 6947 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 6948 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 6949 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 6950 6951 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 6952 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 6953 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 6954 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 6955 // of types. 6956 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 6957 return; 6958 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 6959 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 6960 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 6961 return; 6962 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 6963 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 6964 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 6965 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 6966 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 6967 // extension. 6968 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 6969 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 6970 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 6971 HasNullPtrType = true; 6972 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 6973 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 6974 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) 6975 return; 6976 6977 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 6978 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 6979 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 6980 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 6981 6982 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 6983 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 6984 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 6985 continue; 6986 6987 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6988 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 6989 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 6990 VisibleQuals); 6991 } 6992 } 6993 } 6994 } 6995 6996 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 6997 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 6998 /// given type to the candidate set. 6999 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 7000 QualType T, 7001 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7002 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 7003 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7004 7005 // T& operator=(T&, T) 7006 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 7007 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7008 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7009 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7010 7011 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 7012 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 7013 ParamTypes[0] 7014 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 7015 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7016 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7017 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7018 } 7019 } 7020 7021 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 7022 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 7023 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 7024 Qualifiers VRQuals; 7025 const RecordType *TyRec; 7026 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 7027 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7028 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7029 else 7030 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7031 if (!TyRec) { 7032 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 7033 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7034 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7035 return VRQuals; 7036 } 7037 7038 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7039 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 7040 return VRQuals; 7041 7042 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7043 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7044 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7045 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 7046 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 7047 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7048 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 7049 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 7050 // as see them. 7051 bool done = false; 7052 while (!done) { 7053 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 7054 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7055 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7056 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 7057 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 7058 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7059 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 7060 else 7061 done = true; 7062 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 7063 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7064 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 7065 return VRQuals; 7066 } 7067 } 7068 } 7069 return VRQuals; 7070 } 7071 7072 namespace { 7073 7074 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 7075 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 7076 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 7077 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 7078 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 7079 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 7080 Sema &S; 7081 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 7082 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 7083 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 7084 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 7085 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 7086 7087 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types 7088 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below. 7089 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 7090 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 7091 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3; 7092 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20; 7093 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3, 7094 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11; 7095 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0, 7096 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11; 7097 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20; 7098 7099 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index. 7100 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) { 7101 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes); 7102 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const 7103 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = { 7104 // Start of promoted types. 7105 &ASTContext::FloatTy, 7106 &ASTContext::DoubleTy, 7107 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy, 7108 7109 // Start of integral types. 7110 &ASTContext::IntTy, 7111 &ASTContext::LongTy, 7112 &ASTContext::LongLongTy, 7113 &ASTContext::Int128Ty, 7114 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy, 7115 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy, 7116 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy, 7117 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty, 7118 // End of promoted types. 7119 7120 &ASTContext::BoolTy, 7121 &ASTContext::CharTy, 7122 &ASTContext::WCharTy, 7123 &ASTContext::Char16Ty, 7124 &ASTContext::Char32Ty, 7125 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy, 7126 &ASTContext::ShortTy, 7127 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy, 7128 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy, 7129 // End of integral types. 7130 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 7131 }; 7132 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index]; 7133 } 7134 7135 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic 7136 /// converions for the given arithmetic types. 7137 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) { 7138 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions. 7139 // The rules are basically: 7140 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point 7141 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank 7142 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank 7143 // - use the larger type 7144 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are 7145 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results 7146 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank. 7147 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's 7148 // better not to make any assumptions). 7149 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms. 7150 enum PromotedType { 7151 Dep=-1, 7152 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 7153 }; 7154 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType] 7155 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = { 7156 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt }, 7157 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl }, 7158 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl }, 7159 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 }, 7160 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 }, 7161 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 }, 7162 /*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 }, 7163 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 }, 7164 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 }, 7165 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 }, 7166 /*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 }, 7167 }; 7168 7169 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 7170 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 7171 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R]; 7172 7173 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer. 7174 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx); 7175 7176 // Slow path: we need to compare widths. 7177 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank. 7178 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L), 7179 RT = getArithmeticType(R); 7180 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT), 7181 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT); 7182 7183 // If they're different widths, use the signed type. 7184 if (LW > RW) return LT; 7185 else if (LW < RW) return RT; 7186 7187 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank. 7188 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy; 7189 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL); 7190 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 7191 } 7192 7193 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 7194 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 7195 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 7196 bool HasVolatile, 7197 bool HasRestrict) { 7198 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 7199 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 7200 S.Context.IntTy 7201 }; 7202 7203 // Non-volatile version. 7204 if (Args.size() == 1) 7205 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7206 else 7207 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7208 7209 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 7210 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 7211 if (HasVolatile) { 7212 ParamTypes[0] = 7213 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7214 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 7215 if (Args.size() == 1) 7216 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7217 else 7218 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7219 } 7220 7221 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 7222 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 7223 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 7224 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 7225 ParamTypes[0] 7226 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7227 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 7228 if (Args.size() == 1) 7229 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7230 else 7231 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7232 7233 if (HasVolatile) { 7234 ParamTypes[0] 7235 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7236 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 7237 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 7238 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 7239 if (Args.size() == 1) 7240 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7241 else 7242 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7243 } 7244 } 7245 7246 } 7247 7248 public: 7249 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 7250 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7251 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 7252 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 7253 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 7254 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 7255 : S(S), Args(Args), 7256 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 7257 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 7258 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 7259 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 7260 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 7261 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds. 7262 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy && 7263 "Invalid first promoted integral type"); 7264 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1) 7265 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty && 7266 "Invalid last promoted integral type"); 7267 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType) 7268 == S.Context.FloatTy && 7269 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type"); 7270 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1) 7271 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty && 7272 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type"); 7273 } 7274 7275 // C++ [over.built]p3: 7276 // 7277 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ 7278 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator 7279 // functions of the form 7280 // 7281 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 7282 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 7283 // 7284 // C++ [over.built]p4: 7285 // 7286 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 7287 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 7288 // candidate operator functions of the form 7289 // 7290 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 7291 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 7292 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7293 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7294 return; 7295 7296 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1); 7297 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 7298 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 7299 getArithmeticType(Arith), 7300 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 7301 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 7302 } 7303 } 7304 7305 // C++ [over.built]p5: 7306 // 7307 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 7308 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 7309 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7310 // 7311 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 7312 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 7313 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 7314 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 7315 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 7316 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7317 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7318 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7319 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7320 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 7321 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 7322 continue; 7323 7324 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 7325 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 7326 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 7327 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 7328 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 7329 } 7330 } 7331 7332 // C++ [over.built]p6: 7333 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 7334 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7335 // 7336 // T& operator*(T*); 7337 // 7338 // C++ [over.built]p7: 7339 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 7340 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7341 // T& operator*(T*); 7342 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 7343 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7344 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7345 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7346 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7347 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7348 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 7349 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 7350 continue; 7351 7352 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 7353 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 7354 continue; 7355 7356 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy), 7357 &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7358 } 7359 } 7360 7361 // C++ [over.built]p9: 7362 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 7363 // operator functions of the form 7364 // 7365 // T operator+(T); 7366 // T operator-(T); 7367 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 7368 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7369 return; 7370 7371 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7372 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 7373 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith); 7374 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7375 } 7376 7377 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 7378 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7379 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7380 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7381 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7382 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7383 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7384 } 7385 } 7386 7387 // C++ [over.built]p8: 7388 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 7389 // the form 7390 // 7391 // T* operator+(T*); 7392 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 7393 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7394 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7395 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7396 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7397 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7398 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7399 } 7400 } 7401 7402 // C++ [over.built]p10: 7403 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 7404 // operator functions of the form 7405 // 7406 // T operator~(T); 7407 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 7408 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7409 return; 7410 7411 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7412 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 7413 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int); 7414 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7415 } 7416 7417 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 7418 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7419 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7420 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7421 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7422 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7423 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7424 } 7425 } 7426 7427 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 7428 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator 7429 // functions of the form 7430 // 7431 // bool operator==(T,T); 7432 // bool operator!=(T,T); 7433 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() { 7434 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7435 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7436 7437 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7438 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7439 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 7440 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 7441 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 7442 ++MemPtr) { 7443 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 7444 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 7445 continue; 7446 7447 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 7448 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7449 } 7450 } 7451 } 7452 7453 // C++ [over.built]p15: 7454 // 7455 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or 7456 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7457 // 7458 // bool operator<(T, T); 7459 // bool operator>(T, T); 7460 // bool operator<=(T, T); 7461 // bool operator>=(T, T); 7462 // bool operator==(T, T); 7463 // bool operator!=(T, T); 7464 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 7465 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7466 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 7467 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 7468 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 7469 // candidate. 7470 // 7471 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 7472 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 7473 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 7474 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 7475 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 7476 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 7477 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 7478 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 7479 7480 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7481 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 7482 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 7483 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 7484 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 7485 C != CEnd; ++C) { 7486 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 7487 continue; 7488 7489 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 7490 continue; 7491 7492 QualType FirstParamType = 7493 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7494 QualType SecondParamType = 7495 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7496 7497 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 7498 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 7499 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 7500 continue; 7501 7502 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 7503 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 7504 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 7505 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 7506 } 7507 } 7508 } 7509 7510 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7511 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7512 7513 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7514 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7515 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 7516 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 7517 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7518 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 7519 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 7520 continue; 7521 7522 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 7523 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7524 } 7525 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7526 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 7527 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 7528 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 7529 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 7530 7531 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 7532 // candidate exists. 7533 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 7534 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 7535 CanonType))) 7536 continue; 7537 7538 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 7539 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7540 } 7541 7542 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 7543 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 7544 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second && 7545 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy, 7546 NullPtrTy))) { 7547 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 7548 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 7549 CandidateSet); 7550 } 7551 } 7552 } 7553 } 7554 7555 // C++ [over.built]p13: 7556 // 7557 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 7558 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7559 // 7560 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 7561 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 7562 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 7563 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 7564 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 7565 // 7566 // C++ [over.built]p14: 7567 // 7568 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 7569 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7570 // 7571 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 7572 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7573 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7574 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7575 7576 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 7577 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 7578 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 7579 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 7580 }; 7581 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7582 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 7583 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 7584 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7585 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 7586 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 7587 continue; 7588 7589 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 7590 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 7591 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 7592 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 7593 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7594 } 7595 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 7596 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 7597 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 7598 continue; 7599 7600 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 7601 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes, 7602 Args, CandidateSet); 7603 } 7604 } 7605 } 7606 } 7607 7608 // C++ [over.built]p12: 7609 // 7610 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 7611 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7612 // 7613 // LR operator*(L, R); 7614 // LR operator/(L, R); 7615 // LR operator+(L, R); 7616 // LR operator-(L, R); 7617 // bool operator<(L, R); 7618 // bool operator>(L, R); 7619 // bool operator<=(L, R); 7620 // bool operator>=(L, R); 7621 // bool operator==(L, R); 7622 // bool operator!=(L, R); 7623 // 7624 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 7625 // between types L and R. 7626 // 7627 // C++ [over.built]p24: 7628 // 7629 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 7630 // candidate operator functions of the form 7631 // 7632 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 7633 // 7634 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 7635 // between types L and R. 7636 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 7637 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) { 7638 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7639 return; 7640 7641 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7642 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 7643 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7644 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 7645 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 7646 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 7647 QualType Result = 7648 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy 7649 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 7650 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 7651 } 7652 } 7653 7654 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 7655 // conditional operator for vector types. 7656 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7657 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7658 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7659 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 7660 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7661 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 7662 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 7663 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 7664 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 7665 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy; 7666 if (!isComparison) { 7667 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType()) 7668 Result = *Vec1; 7669 else 7670 Result = *Vec2; 7671 } 7672 7673 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 7674 } 7675 } 7676 } 7677 7678 // C++ [over.built]p17: 7679 // 7680 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 7681 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7682 // 7683 // LR operator%(L, R); 7684 // LR operator&(L, R); 7685 // LR operator^(L, R); 7686 // LR operator|(L, R); 7687 // L operator<<(L, R); 7688 // L operator>>(L, R); 7689 // 7690 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 7691 // between types L and R. 7692 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7693 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7694 return; 7695 7696 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7697 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 7698 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7699 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 7700 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 7701 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 7702 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater) 7703 ? LandR[0] 7704 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 7705 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 7706 } 7707 } 7708 } 7709 7710 // C++ [over.built]p20: 7711 // 7712 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 7713 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 7714 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7715 // 7716 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 7717 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 7718 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7719 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7720 7721 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 7722 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7723 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 7724 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 7725 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 7726 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 7727 continue; 7728 7729 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 7730 } 7731 7732 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7733 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 7734 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 7735 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 7736 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 7737 continue; 7738 7739 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 7740 } 7741 } 7742 } 7743 7744 // C++ [over.built]p19: 7745 // 7746 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 7747 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 7748 // of the form 7749 // 7750 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 7751 // 7752 // C++ [over.built]p21: 7753 // 7754 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 7755 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 7756 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7757 // 7758 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 7759 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 7760 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 7761 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7762 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7763 7764 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7765 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7766 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7767 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7768 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 7769 if (isEqualOp) 7770 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 7771 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 7772 continue; 7773 7774 // non-volatile version 7775 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 7776 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 7777 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 7778 }; 7779 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7780 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 7781 7782 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 7783 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 7784 if (NeedVolatile) { 7785 // volatile version 7786 ParamTypes[0] = 7787 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 7788 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7789 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7790 } 7791 7792 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 7793 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 7794 // restrict version 7795 ParamTypes[0] 7796 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 7797 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7798 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7799 7800 if (NeedVolatile) { 7801 // volatile restrict version 7802 ParamTypes[0] 7803 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7804 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 7805 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 7806 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 7807 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7808 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7809 } 7810 } 7811 } 7812 7813 if (isEqualOp) { 7814 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7815 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 7816 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 7817 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7818 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 7819 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 7820 continue; 7821 7822 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 7823 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 7824 *Ptr, 7825 }; 7826 7827 // non-volatile version 7828 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7829 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 7830 7831 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 7832 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 7833 if (NeedVolatile) { 7834 // volatile version 7835 ParamTypes[0] = 7836 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 7837 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7838 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 7839 } 7840 7841 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 7842 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 7843 // restrict version 7844 ParamTypes[0] 7845 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 7846 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7847 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 7848 7849 if (NeedVolatile) { 7850 // volatile restrict version 7851 ParamTypes[0] 7852 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7853 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 7854 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 7855 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 7856 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7857 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 7858 } 7859 } 7860 } 7861 } 7862 } 7863 7864 // C++ [over.built]p18: 7865 // 7866 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 7867 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 7868 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 7869 // the form 7870 // 7871 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 7872 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 7873 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 7874 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 7875 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 7876 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 7877 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7878 return; 7879 7880 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 7881 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7882 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 7883 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7884 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 7885 7886 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7887 ParamTypes[0] = 7888 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7889 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7890 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7891 7892 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7893 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7894 ParamTypes[0] = 7895 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7896 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7897 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7898 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7899 } 7900 } 7901 } 7902 7903 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 7904 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7905 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7906 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7907 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 7908 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7909 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 7910 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 7911 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 7912 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7913 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 7914 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7915 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 7916 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7917 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7918 7919 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7920 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7921 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 7922 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7923 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7924 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 7925 } 7926 } 7927 } 7928 } 7929 7930 // C++ [over.built]p22: 7931 // 7932 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 7933 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 7934 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7935 // 7936 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 7937 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 7938 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 7939 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 7940 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 7941 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 7942 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 7943 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7944 return; 7945 7946 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 7947 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7948 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 7949 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7950 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 7951 7952 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 7953 ParamTypes[0] = 7954 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 7955 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7956 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 7957 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 7958 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left); 7959 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 7960 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 7961 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7962 } 7963 } 7964 } 7965 } 7966 7967 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 7968 // 7969 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 7970 // 7971 // bool operator!(bool); 7972 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 7973 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 7974 void addExclaimOverload() { 7975 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 7976 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 7977 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 7978 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 7979 } 7980 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 7981 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 7982 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7983 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 7984 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 7985 } 7986 7987 // C++ [over.built]p13: 7988 // 7989 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 7990 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7991 // 7992 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 7993 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 7994 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 7995 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 7996 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 7997 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 7998 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7999 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8000 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8001 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8002 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 8003 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8004 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8005 continue; 8006 8007 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 8008 8009 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 8010 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8011 } 8012 8013 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8014 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8015 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8016 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8017 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 8018 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8019 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8020 continue; 8021 8022 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 8023 8024 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 8025 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8026 } 8027 } 8028 8029 // C++ [over.built]p11: 8030 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 8031 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 8032 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 8033 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8034 // 8035 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 8036 // 8037 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 8038 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 8039 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8040 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8041 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8042 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8043 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 8044 QualType C1; 8045 QualifierCollector Q1; 8046 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 8047 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 8048 continue; 8049 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 8050 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 8051 // volatile/restrict type. 8052 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 8053 continue; 8054 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 8055 continue; 8056 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8057 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 8058 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 8059 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8060 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 8061 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 8062 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 8063 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2)) 8064 break; 8065 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 8066 // build CV12 T& 8067 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 8068 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 8069 T.isVolatileQualified()) 8070 continue; 8071 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 8072 T.isRestrictQualified()) 8073 continue; 8074 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 8075 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 8076 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8077 } 8078 } 8079 } 8080 8081 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 8082 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 8083 // therefore added as binary. 8084 // 8085 // C++ [over.built]p25: 8086 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 8087 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8088 // 8089 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 8090 // 8091 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 8092 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8093 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8094 8095 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8096 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8097 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8098 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8099 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8100 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8101 continue; 8102 8103 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8104 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8105 } 8106 8107 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8108 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8109 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8110 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8111 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8112 continue; 8113 8114 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8115 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8116 } 8117 8118 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 8119 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8120 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8121 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8122 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8123 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 8124 continue; 8125 8126 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8127 continue; 8128 8129 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8130 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8131 } 8132 } 8133 } 8134 } 8135 }; 8136 8137 } // end anonymous namespace 8138 8139 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 8140 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 8141 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 8142 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 8143 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 8144 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 8145 SourceLocation OpLoc, 8146 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8147 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8148 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 8149 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 8150 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 8151 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 8152 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8153 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 8154 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 8155 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 8156 8157 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 8158 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 8159 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 8160 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8161 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 8162 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 8163 OpLoc, 8164 true, 8165 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 8166 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 8167 Op == OO_PipePipe), 8168 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 8169 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 8170 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 8171 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 8172 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 8173 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 8174 } 8175 8176 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 8177 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 8178 // 8179 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 8180 // 'bool' overloads. 8181 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 8182 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 8183 return; 8184 8185 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 8186 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 8187 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8188 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8189 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 8190 8191 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 8192 switch (Op) { 8193 case OO_None: 8194 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 8195 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 8196 8197 case OO_New: 8198 case OO_Delete: 8199 case OO_Array_New: 8200 case OO_Array_Delete: 8201 case OO_Call: 8202 llvm_unreachable( 8203 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 8204 8205 case OO_Comma: 8206 case OO_Arrow: 8207 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8208 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 8209 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 8210 break; 8211 8212 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 8213 if (Args.size() == 1) 8214 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 8215 // Fall through. 8216 8217 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 8218 if (Args.size() == 1) { 8219 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 8220 } else { 8221 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 8222 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 8223 } 8224 break; 8225 8226 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 8227 if (Args.size() == 1) 8228 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 8229 else 8230 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 8231 break; 8232 8233 case OO_Slash: 8234 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 8235 break; 8236 8237 case OO_PlusPlus: 8238 case OO_MinusMinus: 8239 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8240 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 8241 break; 8242 8243 case OO_EqualEqual: 8244 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 8245 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads(); 8246 // Fall through. 8247 8248 case OO_Less: 8249 case OO_Greater: 8250 case OO_LessEqual: 8251 case OO_GreaterEqual: 8252 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8253 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true); 8254 break; 8255 8256 case OO_Percent: 8257 case OO_Caret: 8258 case OO_Pipe: 8259 case OO_LessLess: 8260 case OO_GreaterGreater: 8261 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8262 break; 8263 8264 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 8265 if (Args.size() == 1) 8266 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8267 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 8268 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 8269 break; 8270 8271 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8272 break; 8273 8274 case OO_Tilde: 8275 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 8276 break; 8277 8278 case OO_Equal: 8279 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8280 // Fall through. 8281 8282 case OO_PlusEqual: 8283 case OO_MinusEqual: 8284 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8285 // Fall through. 8286 8287 case OO_StarEqual: 8288 case OO_SlashEqual: 8289 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8290 break; 8291 8292 case OO_PercentEqual: 8293 case OO_LessLessEqual: 8294 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 8295 case OO_AmpEqual: 8296 case OO_CaretEqual: 8297 case OO_PipeEqual: 8298 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 8299 break; 8300 8301 case OO_Exclaim: 8302 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 8303 break; 8304 8305 case OO_AmpAmp: 8306 case OO_PipePipe: 8307 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 8308 break; 8309 8310 case OO_Subscript: 8311 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 8312 break; 8313 8314 case OO_ArrowStar: 8315 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 8316 break; 8317 8318 case OO_Conditional: 8319 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 8320 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 8321 break; 8322 } 8323 } 8324 8325 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 8326 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 8327 /// 8328 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 8329 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 8330 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 8331 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 8332 void 8333 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 8334 SourceLocation Loc, 8335 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8336 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8337 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 8338 bool PartialOverloading) { 8339 ADLResult Fns; 8340 8341 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 8342 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 8343 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 8344 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 8345 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 8346 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 8347 8348 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 8349 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 8350 8351 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 8352 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 8353 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8354 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 8355 if (Cand->Function) { 8356 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 8357 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 8358 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 8359 } 8360 8361 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 8362 // set. 8363 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 8364 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 8365 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 8366 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 8367 continue; 8368 8369 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 8370 PartialOverloading); 8371 } else 8372 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 8373 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8374 Args, CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 8375 } 8376 } 8377 8378 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 8379 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 8380 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 8381 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 8382 SourceLocation Loc, 8383 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 8384 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 8385 // functions. 8386 if (!Cand2.Viable) 8387 return Cand1.Viable; 8388 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 8389 return false; 8390 8391 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 8392 // 8393 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 8394 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 8395 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 8396 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 8397 unsigned StartArg = 0; 8398 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 8399 StartArg = 1; 8400 8401 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 8402 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 8403 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 8404 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 8405 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions; 8406 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 8407 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 8408 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 8409 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 8410 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 8411 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 8412 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 8413 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 8414 HasBetterConversion = true; 8415 break; 8416 8417 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 8418 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 8419 return false; 8420 8421 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 8422 // Do nothing. 8423 break; 8424 } 8425 } 8426 8427 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 8428 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 8429 if (HasBetterConversion) 8430 return true; 8431 8432 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 8433 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 8434 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 8435 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 8436 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 8437 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 8438 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 8439 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 8440 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 8441 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 8442 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 8443 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 8444 // pointer or block. 8445 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 8446 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 8447 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 8448 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 8449 Cand1.FinalConversion, 8450 Cand2.FinalConversion); 8451 8452 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 8453 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 8454 8455 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 8456 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 8457 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 8458 } 8459 8460 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 8461 // specialization, or, if not that, 8462 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 8463 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8464 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 8465 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8466 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 8467 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 8468 8469 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 8470 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 8471 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 8472 // if not that, 8473 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 8474 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 8475 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 8476 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 8477 Loc, 8478 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 8479 : TPOC_Call, 8480 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, 8481 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments)) 8482 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8483 } 8484 8485 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 8486 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 8487 (Cand1.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>() || 8488 Cand2.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>())) { 8489 // FIXME: The next several lines are just 8490 // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order, 8491 // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST. 8492 AttrVec Cand1Attrs; 8493 if (Cand1.Function->hasAttrs()) { 8494 Cand1Attrs = Cand1.Function->getAttrs(); 8495 Cand1Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end(), 8496 IsNotEnableIfAttr), 8497 Cand1Attrs.end()); 8498 std::reverse(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end()); 8499 } 8500 8501 AttrVec Cand2Attrs; 8502 if (Cand2.Function->hasAttrs()) { 8503 Cand2Attrs = Cand2.Function->getAttrs(); 8504 Cand2Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end(), 8505 IsNotEnableIfAttr), 8506 Cand2Attrs.end()); 8507 std::reverse(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end()); 8508 } 8509 8510 // Candidate 1 is better if it has strictly more attributes and 8511 // the common sequence is identical. 8512 if (Cand1Attrs.size() <= Cand2Attrs.size()) 8513 return false; 8514 8515 auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin(); 8516 for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) { 8517 auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++; 8518 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 8519 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, 8520 S.getASTContext(), true); 8521 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, 8522 S.getASTContext(), true); 8523 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 8524 return false; 8525 } 8526 8527 return true; 8528 } 8529 8530 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads && 8531 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 8532 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 8533 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 8534 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 8535 } 8536 8537 return false; 8538 } 8539 8540 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 8541 /// within an overload candidate set. 8542 /// 8543 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 8544 /// which overload resolution occurs. 8545 /// 8546 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 8547 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 8548 /// 8549 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 8550 OverloadingResult 8551 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8552 iterator &Best, 8553 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 8554 // Find the best viable function. 8555 Best = end(); 8556 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 8557 if (Cand->Viable) 8558 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, 8559 UserDefinedConversion)) 8560 Best = Cand; 8561 } 8562 8563 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 8564 if (Best == end()) 8565 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 8566 8567 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 8568 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 8569 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 8570 if (Cand->Viable && 8571 Cand != Best && 8572 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, 8573 UserDefinedConversion)) { 8574 Best = end(); 8575 return OR_Ambiguous; 8576 } 8577 } 8578 8579 // Best is the best viable function. 8580 if (Best->Function && 8581 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 8582 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function))) 8583 return OR_Deleted; 8584 8585 return OR_Success; 8586 } 8587 8588 namespace { 8589 8590 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 8591 oc_function, 8592 oc_method, 8593 oc_constructor, 8594 oc_function_template, 8595 oc_method_template, 8596 oc_constructor_template, 8597 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 8598 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 8599 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 8600 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 8601 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 8602 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor 8603 }; 8604 8605 OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 8606 FunctionDecl *Fn, 8607 std::string &Description) { 8608 bool isTemplate = false; 8609 8610 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 8611 isTemplate = true; 8612 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 8613 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 8614 } 8615 8616 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 8617 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) 8618 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor; 8619 8620 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor()) 8621 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor; 8622 8623 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 8624 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 8625 8626 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 8627 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 8628 8629 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 8630 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 8631 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 8632 } 8633 8634 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 8635 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 8636 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 8637 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 8638 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method; 8639 8640 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 8641 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 8642 8643 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 8644 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 8645 8646 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 8647 return oc_method; 8648 } 8649 8650 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function; 8651 } 8652 8653 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) { 8654 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn); 8655 if (!Ctor) return; 8656 8657 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor(); 8658 if (!Ctor) return; 8659 8660 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor); 8661 } 8662 8663 } // end anonymous namespace 8664 8665 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 8666 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) { 8667 std::string FnDesc; 8668 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc); 8669 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 8670 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc; 8671 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 8672 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 8673 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn); 8674 } 8675 8676 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 8677 // OverloadedExpr 8678 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) { 8679 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 8680 8681 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 8682 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 8683 8684 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 8685 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 8686 I != IEnd; ++I) { 8687 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 8688 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 8689 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType); 8690 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 8691 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 8692 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType); 8693 } 8694 } 8695 } 8696 8697 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 8698 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 8699 /// target types of the conversion. 8700 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 8701 Sema &S, 8702 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 8703 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 8704 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 8705 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 8706 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 8707 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 8708 // refactoring here. 8709 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 8710 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 8711 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 8712 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 8713 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 8714 break; 8715 ++CandsShown; 8716 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I); 8717 } 8718 if (I != E) 8719 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 8720 } 8721 8722 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8723 unsigned I) { 8724 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 8725 assert(Conv.isBad()); 8726 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 8727 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 8728 8729 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 8730 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 8731 // conversion-slot index. 8732 bool isObjectArgument = false; 8733 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 8734 if (I == 0) 8735 isObjectArgument = true; 8736 else 8737 I--; 8738 } 8739 8740 std::string FnDesc; 8741 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 8742 8743 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 8744 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 8745 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 8746 8747 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 8748 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 8749 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 8750 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 8751 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 8752 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 8753 8754 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 8755 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8756 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8757 << ToTy << Name << I+1; 8758 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8759 return; 8760 } 8761 8762 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 8763 // to a qualifier mismatch. 8764 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 8765 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 8766 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8767 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 8768 else { 8769 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 8770 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8771 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8772 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 8773 } 8774 8775 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 8776 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 8777 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 8778 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 8779 8780 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 8781 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 8782 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8783 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8784 << FromTy 8785 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 8786 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8787 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8788 return; 8789 } 8790 8791 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 8792 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 8793 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8794 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8795 << FromTy 8796 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 8797 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8798 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8799 return; 8800 } 8801 8802 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 8803 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 8804 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8805 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8806 << FromTy 8807 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 8808 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8809 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8810 return; 8811 } 8812 8813 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 8814 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 8815 8816 if (isObjectArgument) { 8817 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 8818 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8819 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8820 << FromTy << (CVR - 1); 8821 } else { 8822 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 8823 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8824 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8825 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1; 8826 } 8827 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8828 return; 8829 } 8830 8831 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 8832 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 8833 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 8834 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 8835 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8836 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8837 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8838 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8839 return; 8840 } 8841 8842 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 8843 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 8844 // the failure. 8845 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 8846 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8847 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 8848 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 8849 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 8850 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8851 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8852 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8853 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8854 return; 8855 } 8856 8857 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 8858 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 8859 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8860 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8861 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 8862 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 8863 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 8864 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 8865 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 8866 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 8867 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 8868 } 8869 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 8870 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 8871 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 8872 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 8873 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 8874 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 8875 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 8876 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 8877 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 8878 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 8879 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 8880 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 8881 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 8882 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 8883 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 8884 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 8885 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 8886 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 8887 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 8888 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 8889 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8890 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8891 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1; 8892 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8893 return; 8894 } 8895 } 8896 8897 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 8898 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 8899 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 8900 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8901 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8902 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) 8903 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1; 8904 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8905 return; 8906 } 8907 8908 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 8909 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 8910 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 8911 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 8912 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 8913 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 8914 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8915 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8916 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 8917 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8918 return; 8919 } 8920 } 8921 8922 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 8923 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 8924 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 8925 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8926 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1 8927 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind); 8928 8929 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 8930 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 8931 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 8932 FDiag << *HI; 8933 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 8934 8935 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 8936 } 8937 8938 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 8939 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 8940 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 8941 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 8942 unsigned NumArgs) { 8943 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 8944 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 8945 8946 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 8947 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 8948 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 8949 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 8950 // Just don't report anything. 8951 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 8952 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 8953 return true; 8954 8955 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 8956 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 8957 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 8958 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 8959 } else { 8960 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 8961 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 8962 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 8963 } 8964 8965 return false; 8966 } 8967 8968 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 8969 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 8970 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 8971 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 8972 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 8973 " or too few arguments"); 8974 8975 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 8976 8977 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 8978 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 8979 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 8980 8981 // at least / at most / exactly 8982 unsigned mode, modeCount; 8983 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 8984 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 8985 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 8986 mode = 0; // "at least" 8987 else 8988 mode = 2; // "exactly" 8989 modeCount = MinParams; 8990 } else { 8991 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 8992 mode = 1; // "at most" 8993 else 8994 mode = 2; // "exactly" 8995 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 8996 } 8997 8998 std::string Description; 8999 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description); 9000 9001 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 9002 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 9003 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr) 9004 << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 9005 else 9006 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 9007 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr) 9008 << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 9009 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 9010 } 9011 9012 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 9013 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9014 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 9015 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 9016 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 9017 } 9018 9019 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 9020 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)) 9021 return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 9022 else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated)) 9023 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 9024 9025 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 9026 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 9027 } 9028 9029 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 9030 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated, 9031 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 9032 unsigned NumArgs) { 9033 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 9034 NamedDecl *ParamD; 9035 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 9036 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 9037 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 9038 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 9039 case Sema::TDK_Success: 9040 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 9041 9042 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 9043 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 9044 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9045 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 9046 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9047 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9048 return; 9049 } 9050 9051 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 9052 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 9053 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 9054 9055 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 9056 9057 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 9058 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 9059 QualifierCollector Qs; 9060 Qs.strip(Param); 9061 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 9062 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 9063 9064 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 9065 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 9066 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 9067 // done on dependent types). 9068 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 9069 9070 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 9071 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 9072 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9073 return; 9074 } 9075 9076 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 9077 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 9078 int which = 0; 9079 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9080 which = 0; 9081 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9082 which = 1; 9083 else { 9084 which = 2; 9085 } 9086 9087 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9088 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 9089 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 9090 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 9091 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9092 return; 9093 } 9094 9095 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 9096 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 9097 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 9098 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9099 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 9100 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9101 else { 9102 int index = 0; 9103 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9104 index = TTP->getIndex(); 9105 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 9106 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9107 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 9108 else 9109 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 9110 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9111 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 9112 << (index + 1); 9113 } 9114 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9115 return; 9116 9117 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 9118 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 9119 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs); 9120 return; 9121 9122 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 9123 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9124 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 9125 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9126 return; 9127 9128 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 9129 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 9130 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 9131 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 9132 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 9133 TemplateArgString = " "; 9134 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9135 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 9136 } 9137 9138 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 9139 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 9140 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 9141 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 9142 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 9143 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 9144 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 9145 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 9146 return; 9147 } 9148 9149 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 9150 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 9151 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 9152 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 9153 SourceRange R; 9154 if (PDiag) { 9155 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 9156 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 9157 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 9158 } 9159 9160 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9161 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 9162 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 9163 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9164 return; 9165 } 9166 9167 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: { 9168 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr()); 9169 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9170 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution) 9171 << R.Expression->getName(); 9172 return; 9173 } 9174 9175 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 9176 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 9177 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 9178 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 9179 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 9180 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 9181 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 9182 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 9183 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 9184 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 9185 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 9186 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 9187 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 9188 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 9189 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 9190 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 9191 // name for types, not decls. 9192 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 9193 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9194 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 9195 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 9196 return; 9197 } 9198 } 9199 } 9200 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 9201 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 9202 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 9203 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 9204 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9205 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 9206 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 9207 return; 9208 } 9209 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 9210 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 9211 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 9212 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 9213 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated); 9214 return; 9215 } 9216 } 9217 9218 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 9219 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9220 unsigned NumArgs) { 9221 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 9222 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 9223 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 9224 return; 9225 } 9226 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern 9227 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs); 9228 } 9229 9230 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 9231 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9232 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9233 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 9234 9235 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 9236 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 9237 9238 std::string FnDesc; 9239 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc); 9240 9241 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 9242 << (unsigned)FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 9243 9244 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 9245 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 9246 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 9247 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 9248 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 9249 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 9250 9251 switch (FnKind) { 9252 default: 9253 return; 9254 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 9255 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 9256 break; 9257 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 9258 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 9259 break; 9260 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 9261 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 9262 break; 9263 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 9264 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 9265 break; 9266 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 9267 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 9268 break; 9269 }; 9270 9271 bool ConstRHS = false; 9272 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 9273 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 9274 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 9275 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 9276 } 9277 } 9278 9279 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 9280 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 9281 /* Diagnose */ true); 9282 } 9283 } 9284 9285 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9286 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 9287 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 9288 9289 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 9290 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) 9291 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 9292 } 9293 9294 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 9295 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 9296 /// 9297 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 9298 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 9299 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 9300 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 9301 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 9302 /// overload. 9303 /// 9304 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 9305 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 9306 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 9307 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9308 unsigned NumArgs) { 9309 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 9310 9311 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 9312 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || 9313 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) { 9314 std::string FnDesc; 9315 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 9316 9317 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 9318 << FnKind << FnDesc 9319 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 9320 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 9321 return; 9322 } 9323 9324 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 9325 if (Cand->Viable) { 9326 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 9327 return; 9328 } 9329 9330 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 9331 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 9332 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 9333 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 9334 9335 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 9336 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs); 9337 9338 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 9339 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 9340 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 9341 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 9342 return; 9343 } 9344 9345 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 9346 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 9347 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 9348 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 9349 9350 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 9351 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 9352 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I) 9353 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 9354 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I); 9355 9356 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 9357 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 9358 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 9359 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 9360 } 9361 9362 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 9363 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 9364 9365 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 9366 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 9367 } 9368 } 9369 9370 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9371 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 9372 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 9373 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 9374 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 9375 bool isLValueReference = false; 9376 bool isRValueReference = false; 9377 bool isPointer = false; 9378 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 9379 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 9380 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 9381 isLValueReference = true; 9382 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 9383 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 9384 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 9385 isRValueReference = true; 9386 } 9387 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9388 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 9389 isPointer = true; 9390 } 9391 // Desugar down to a function type. 9392 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 9393 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 9394 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 9395 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 9396 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 9397 9398 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 9399 << FnType; 9400 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate); 9401 } 9402 9403 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 9404 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9405 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9406 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 9407 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 9408 TypeStr += Opc; 9409 TypeStr += "("; 9410 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 9411 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) { 9412 TypeStr += ")"; 9413 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 9414 } else { 9415 TypeStr += ", "; 9416 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 9417 TypeStr += ")"; 9418 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 9419 } 9420 } 9421 9422 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9423 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9424 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions; 9425 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) { 9426 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx]; 9427 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 9428 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 9429 9430 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc, 9431 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 9432 } 9433 } 9434 9435 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9436 if (Cand->Function) 9437 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 9438 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 9439 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 9440 return SourceLocation(); 9441 } 9442 9443 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 9444 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 9445 case Sema::TDK_Success: 9446 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 9447 9448 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 9449 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 9450 return 1; 9451 9452 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 9453 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 9454 return 2; 9455 9456 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 9457 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 9458 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 9459 return 3; 9460 9461 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 9462 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 9463 return 4; 9464 9465 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 9466 return 5; 9467 9468 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 9469 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 9470 return 6; 9471 } 9472 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 9473 } 9474 9475 namespace { 9476 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 9477 Sema &S; 9478 size_t NumArgs; 9479 9480 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, size_t nArgs) 9481 : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {} 9482 9483 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 9484 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 9485 // Fast-path this check. 9486 if (L == R) return false; 9487 9488 // Order first by viability. 9489 if (L->Viable) { 9490 if (!R->Viable) return true; 9491 9492 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 9493 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 9494 // that could exploit it. 9495 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true; 9496 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false; 9497 } else if (R->Viable) 9498 return false; 9499 9500 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 9501 9502 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 9503 if (!L->Viable) { 9504 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 9505 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 9506 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 9507 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 9508 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 9509 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 9510 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 9511 if (LDist == RDist) { 9512 if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind) 9513 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 9514 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 9515 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 9516 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 9517 // than there were arguments given. 9518 return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 9519 } 9520 return LDist < RDist; 9521 } 9522 return false; 9523 } 9524 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 9525 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 9526 return true; 9527 9528 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 9529 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 9530 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 9531 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 9532 return true; 9533 9534 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 9535 // comes first. 9536 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 9537 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 9538 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 9539 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 9540 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 9541 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 9542 } 9543 9544 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 9545 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 9546 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions); 9547 9548 int leftBetter = 0; 9549 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 9550 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) { 9551 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 9552 L->Conversions[I], 9553 R->Conversions[I])) { 9554 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9555 leftBetter++; 9556 break; 9557 9558 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9559 leftBetter--; 9560 break; 9561 9562 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9563 break; 9564 } 9565 } 9566 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 9567 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 9568 9569 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 9570 return false; 9571 9572 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 9573 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 9574 return true; 9575 9576 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 9577 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 9578 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 9579 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 9580 return false; 9581 9582 // TODO: others? 9583 } 9584 9585 // Sort everything else by location. 9586 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 9587 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 9588 9589 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 9590 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 9591 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 9592 9593 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 9594 } 9595 }; 9596 } 9597 9598 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 9599 /// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible. 9600 static void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9601 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 9602 assert(!Cand->Viable); 9603 9604 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 9605 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 9606 9607 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 9608 bool Unfixable = false; 9609 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 9610 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 9611 9612 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion. 9613 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 9614 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions; 9615 while (true) { 9616 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 9617 ConvIdx++; 9618 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) { 9619 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S); 9620 break; 9621 } 9622 } 9623 9624 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount) 9625 return; 9626 9627 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 9628 "remaining conversion is initialized?"); 9629 9630 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 9631 // operation somehow. 9632 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 9633 9634 const FunctionProtoType* Proto; 9635 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx; 9636 9637 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 9638 QualType ConvType 9639 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 9640 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 9641 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 9642 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9643 ArgIdx--; 9644 } else if (Cand->Function) { 9645 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9646 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 9647 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) 9648 ArgIdx--; 9649 } else { 9650 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion. 9651 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 9652 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx) 9653 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 9654 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx], 9655 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx], 9656 SuppressUserConversions, 9657 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true, 9658 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 9659 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 9660 return; 9661 } 9662 9663 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 9664 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 9665 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 9666 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 9667 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 9668 S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx), SuppressUserConversions, 9669 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 9670 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 9671 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 9672 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 9673 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 9674 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 9675 } 9676 else 9677 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 9678 } 9679 } 9680 9681 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints 9682 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate 9683 /// set. 9684 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, 9685 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 9686 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9687 StringRef Opc, 9688 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9689 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 9690 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 9691 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 9692 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 9693 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 9694 if (Cand->Viable) 9695 Cands.push_back(Cand); 9696 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 9697 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args); 9698 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 9699 Cands.push_back(Cand); 9700 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 9701 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 9702 } 9703 } 9704 9705 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 9706 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, Args.size())); 9707 9708 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 9709 9710 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 9711 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 9712 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 9713 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9714 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 9715 9716 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 9717 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 9718 // candidate list. 9719 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 9720 break; 9721 } 9722 ++CandsShown; 9723 9724 if (Cand->Function) 9725 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size()); 9726 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 9727 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 9728 else { 9729 assert(Cand->Viable && 9730 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 9731 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 9732 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 9733 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 9734 // 9735 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 9736 // different ambiguities, though. 9737 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 9738 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 9739 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 9740 } 9741 9742 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 9743 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 9744 } 9745 } 9746 9747 if (I != E) 9748 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 9749 } 9750 9751 static SourceLocation 9752 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 9753 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 9754 : SourceLocation(); 9755 } 9756 9757 namespace { 9758 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 9759 Sema &S; 9760 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 9761 9762 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 9763 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 9764 // Fast-path this check. 9765 if (L == R) 9766 return false; 9767 9768 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 9769 9770 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 9771 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 9772 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 9773 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 9774 9775 // Sort everything else by location. 9776 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 9777 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 9778 9779 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 9780 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 9781 return false; 9782 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 9783 return true; 9784 9785 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 9786 } 9787 }; 9788 } 9789 9790 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 9791 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 9792 /// deductions. 9793 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) { 9794 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern 9795 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0); 9796 } 9797 9798 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 9799 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 9800 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 9801 } 9802 } 9803 9804 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 9805 destroyCandidates(); 9806 Candidates.clear(); 9807 } 9808 9809 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 9810 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 9811 /// the candidate set. 9812 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 9813 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 9814 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 9815 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 9816 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 9817 // and sort those. 9818 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 9819 Cands.reserve(size()); 9820 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 9821 if (Cand->Specialization) 9822 Cands.push_back(Cand); 9823 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 9824 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 9825 } 9826 9827 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 9828 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 9829 9830 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 9831 // for generalization purposes (?). 9832 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 9833 9834 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 9835 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 9836 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9837 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 9838 9839 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 9840 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 9841 // candidate list. 9842 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 9843 break; 9844 ++CandsShown; 9845 9846 assert(Cand->Specialization && 9847 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 9848 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S); 9849 } 9850 9851 if (I != E) 9852 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 9853 } 9854 9855 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 9856 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 9857 // R (A) --> R(A) 9858 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 9859 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 9860 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 9861 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 9862 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 9863 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 9864 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 9865 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 9866 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 9867 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9868 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 9869 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 9870 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 9871 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 9872 Ret = 9873 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 9874 return Ret; 9875 } 9876 9877 namespace { 9878 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 9879 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 9880 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 9881 Sema& S; 9882 Expr* SourceExpr; 9883 const QualType& TargetType; 9884 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 9885 9886 bool Complain; 9887 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 9888 ASTContext& Context; 9889 9890 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 9891 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 9892 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 9893 9894 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 9895 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 9896 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 9897 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 9898 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 9899 9900 public: 9901 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 9902 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 9903 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 9904 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 9905 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 9906 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 9907 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 9908 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 9909 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 9910 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 9911 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) { 9912 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 9913 9914 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 9915 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 9916 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 9917 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 9918 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 9919 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 9920 DeclAccessPair dap; 9921 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9922 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 9923 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 9924 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 9925 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 9926 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 9927 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 9928 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 9929 9930 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 9931 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 9932 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 9933 return; 9934 } 9935 9936 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 9937 } 9938 return; 9939 } 9940 9941 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 9942 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 9943 9944 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 9945 // C++ [over.over]p4: 9946 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 9947 if (Matches.size() > 1) { 9948 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 9949 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 9950 else 9951 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 9952 } 9953 } 9954 9955 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads && 9956 Matches.size() > 1) 9957 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 9958 } 9959 9960 private: 9961 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 9962 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 9963 } 9964 9965 // [ToType] [Return] 9966 9967 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 9968 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 9969 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 9970 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 9971 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 9972 } 9973 9974 // return true if any matching specializations were found 9975 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 9976 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 9977 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 9978 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9979 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 9980 // static when converting to member pointer. 9981 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 9982 return false; 9983 } 9984 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 9985 return false; 9986 9987 // C++ [over.over]p2: 9988 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 9989 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 9990 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 9991 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 9992 // overloaded functions considered. 9993 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 9994 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 9995 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 9996 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 9997 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 9998 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 9999 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) { 10000 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 10001 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 10002 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 10003 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 10004 return false; 10005 } 10006 10007 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 10008 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 10009 // This function template specicalization works. 10010 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl()); 10011 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 10012 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 10013 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 10014 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 10015 return true; 10016 } 10017 10018 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 10019 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 10020 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10021 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 10022 // when converting to member pointer. 10023 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10024 return false; 10025 } 10026 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10027 return false; 10028 10029 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 10030 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 10031 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 10032 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl)) 10033 return false; 10034 10035 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 10036 // now. 10037 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 10038 FunDecl->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 10039 S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain)) 10040 return false; 10041 10042 QualType ResultTy; 10043 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, 10044 FunDecl->getType()) || 10045 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType, 10046 ResultTy)) { 10047 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, 10048 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 10049 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 10050 return true; 10051 } 10052 } 10053 10054 return false; 10055 } 10056 10057 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 10058 bool Ret = false; 10059 10060 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 10061 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 10062 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 10063 return false; 10064 10065 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10066 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10067 I != E; ++I) { 10068 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 10069 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 10070 10071 // C++ [over.over]p3: 10072 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 10073 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 10074 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 10075 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 10076 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 10077 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 10078 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 10079 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 10080 Ret = true; 10081 } 10082 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 10083 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 10084 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 10085 Ret = true; 10086 } 10087 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 10088 return Ret; 10089 } 10090 10091 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 10092 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 10093 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 10094 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 10095 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 10096 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 10097 10098 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 10099 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 10100 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 10101 // best function template (if it exists). 10102 10103 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 10104 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 10105 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 10106 10107 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 10108 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 10109 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 10110 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 10111 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(), 10112 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0] 10113 .second->getDeclName(), 10114 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template, 10115 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 10116 10117 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 10118 // Make it the first and only element 10119 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 10120 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 10121 Matches.resize(1); 10122 } 10123 } 10124 10125 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 10126 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 10127 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 10128 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 10129 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 10130 ++I; 10131 else { 10132 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 10133 Matches.resize(N); 10134 } 10135 } 10136 } 10137 10138 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 10139 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 10140 } 10141 10142 public: 10143 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 10144 assert(Matches.empty()); 10145 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 10146 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 10147 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10148 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 10149 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 10150 else { 10151 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 10152 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 10153 // normally. 10154 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10155 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10156 I != IEnd; ++I) 10157 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 10158 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 10159 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType); 10160 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart()); 10161 } 10162 } 10163 10164 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 10165 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 10166 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 10167 } 10168 10169 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 10170 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 10171 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 10172 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 10173 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 10174 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10175 } 10176 10177 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 10178 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 10179 } 10180 10181 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 10182 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), 10183 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 10184 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10185 } 10186 10187 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 10188 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 10189 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 10190 } 10191 10192 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 10193 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 10194 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 10195 << OvlExpr->getName() 10196 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10197 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 10198 } 10199 10200 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 10201 10202 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 10203 10204 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 10205 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 10206 return Matches[0].second; 10207 } 10208 10209 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 10210 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 10211 return &Matches[0].first; 10212 } 10213 }; 10214 } 10215 10216 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 10217 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 10218 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 10219 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 10220 /// 10221 /// @code 10222 /// int f(double); 10223 /// int f(int); 10224 /// 10225 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 10226 /// @endcode 10227 /// 10228 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 10229 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 10230 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 10231 FunctionDecl * 10232 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 10233 QualType TargetType, 10234 bool Complain, 10235 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 10236 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 10237 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10238 10239 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 10240 Complain); 10241 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 10242 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 10243 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) { 10244 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 10245 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 10246 else 10247 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 10248 } 10249 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain) 10250 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 10251 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 10252 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 10253 assert(Fn); 10254 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 10255 if (Complain) { 10256 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 10257 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 10258 else 10259 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 10260 } 10261 } 10262 10263 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 10264 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 10265 return Fn; 10266 } 10267 10268 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 10269 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 10270 /// 10271 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 10272 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 10273 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 10274 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 10275 /// 10276 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 10277 /// returned. 10278 FunctionDecl * 10279 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 10280 bool Complain, 10281 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 10282 // C++ [over.over]p1: 10283 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 10284 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 10285 // C++ [over.over]p1: 10286 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 10287 // operator. 10288 10289 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 10290 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 10291 return nullptr; 10292 10293 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 10294 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 10295 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 10296 10297 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 10298 // whose type matches exactly. 10299 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 10300 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 10301 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 10302 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 10303 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 10304 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 10305 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 10306 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 10307 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 10308 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 10309 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 10310 10311 // C++ [over.over]p2: 10312 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 10313 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 10314 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 10315 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 10316 // overloaded functions considered. 10317 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 10318 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 10319 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 10320 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 10321 Specialization, Info, 10322 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) { 10323 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 10324 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 10325 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 10326 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 10327 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 10328 continue; 10329 } 10330 10331 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 10332 10333 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 10334 if (Matched) { 10335 if (Complain) { 10336 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 10337 << ovl->getName(); 10338 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 10339 } 10340 return nullptr; 10341 } 10342 10343 Matched = Specialization; 10344 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 10345 } 10346 10347 if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 10348 Matched->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 10349 DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 10350 return nullptr; 10351 10352 return Matched; 10353 } 10354 10355 10356 10357 10358 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 10359 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 10360 // 10361 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 10362 // 10363 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 10364 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 10365 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 10366 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 10367 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 10368 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 10369 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 10370 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 10371 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10372 10373 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 10374 10375 DeclAccessPair found; 10376 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 10377 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 10378 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 10379 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) { 10380 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 10381 return true; 10382 } 10383 10384 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 10385 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 10386 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 10387 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 10388 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 10389 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 10390 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 10391 if (!complain) return false; 10392 10393 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 10394 diag::err_bound_member_function) 10395 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 10396 10397 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 10398 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 10399 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 10400 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 10401 // the static candidates were rejected. 10402 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 10403 return true; 10404 } 10405 10406 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 10407 SingleFunctionExpression = 10408 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 10409 10410 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 10411 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 10412 SingleFunctionExpression = 10413 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 10414 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 10415 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 10416 return true; 10417 } 10418 } 10419 } 10420 10421 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 10422 if (complain) { 10423 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 10424 << ovl.Expression->getName() 10425 << DestTypeForComplaining 10426 << OpRangeForComplaining 10427 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 10428 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 10429 10430 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 10431 return true; 10432 } 10433 10434 return false; 10435 } 10436 10437 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 10438 return true; 10439 } 10440 10441 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set. 10442 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 10443 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 10444 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 10445 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10446 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 10447 bool PartialOverloading, 10448 bool KnownValid) { 10449 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 10450 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 10451 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 10452 10453 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 10454 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 10455 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 10456 return; 10457 } 10458 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 10459 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 10460 PartialOverloading); 10461 return; 10462 } 10463 10464 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 10465 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 10466 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 10467 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 10468 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 10469 PartialOverloading); 10470 return; 10471 } 10472 10473 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 10474 } 10475 10476 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 10477 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 10478 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 10479 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10480 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 10481 bool PartialOverloading) { 10482 10483 #ifndef NDEBUG 10484 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 10485 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 10486 // 10487 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 10488 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 10489 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 10490 // 10491 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 10492 // 10493 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 10494 // using-declaration, or 10495 // 10496 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 10497 // template 10498 // 10499 // then Y is empty. 10500 10501 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 10502 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 10503 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 10504 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 10505 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 10506 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 10507 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 10508 } 10509 } 10510 #endif 10511 10512 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 10513 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 10514 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 10515 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10516 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 10517 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 10518 } 10519 10520 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 10521 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 10522 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 10523 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 10524 /*KnownValid*/ true); 10525 10526 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 10527 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 10528 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 10529 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 10530 } 10531 10532 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 10533 /// a different namespace. 10534 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 10535 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 10536 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 10537 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 10538 return false; 10539 10540 default: 10541 return true; 10542 } 10543 } 10544 10545 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 10546 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 10547 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 10548 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 10549 /// 10550 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 10551 static bool 10552 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 10553 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 10554 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 10555 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 10556 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10557 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 10558 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty()) 10559 return false; 10560 10561 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 10562 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 10563 continue; 10564 10565 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 10566 10567 if (!R.empty()) { 10568 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 10569 10570 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 10571 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 10572 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 10573 R.clear(); 10574 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 10575 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 10576 return false; 10577 } 10578 10579 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 10580 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 10581 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 10582 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 10583 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 10584 10585 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10586 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 10587 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 10588 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 10589 R.clear(); 10590 return false; 10591 } 10592 10593 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 10594 // declaring the function there instead. 10595 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 10596 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 10597 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 10598 AssociatedNamespaces, 10599 AssociatedClasses); 10600 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 10601 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 10602 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 10603 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 10604 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 10605 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 10606 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 10607 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 10608 continue; 10609 10610 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 10611 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 10612 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 10613 if (NS && 10614 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 10615 continue; 10616 10617 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 10618 } 10619 } 10620 10621 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 10622 << R.getLookupName(); 10623 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 10624 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 10625 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 10626 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 10627 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 10628 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 10629 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 10630 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 10631 } else { 10632 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 10633 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 10634 // a localized representation of a list of items. 10635 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 10636 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 10637 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 10638 } 10639 10640 // Try to recover by calling this function. 10641 return true; 10642 } 10643 10644 R.clear(); 10645 } 10646 10647 return false; 10648 } 10649 10650 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 10651 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 10652 /// was defined. 10653 /// 10654 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 10655 static bool 10656 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 10657 SourceLocation OpLoc, 10658 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 10659 DeclarationName OpName = 10660 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 10661 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 10662 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 10663 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 10664 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 10665 } 10666 10667 namespace { 10668 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 10669 Sema &SemaRef; 10670 public: 10671 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 10672 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 10673 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 10674 } 10675 10676 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 10677 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 10678 } 10679 }; 10680 10681 } 10682 10683 static std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> 10684 MakeValidator(Sema &SemaRef, MemberExpr *ME, size_t NumArgs, 10685 bool HasTemplateArgs, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 10686 if (!AllowTypoCorrection) 10687 return llvm::make_unique<NoTypoCorrectionCCC>(); 10688 return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallFilterCCC>(SemaRef, NumArgs, 10689 HasTemplateArgs, ME); 10690 } 10691 10692 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 10693 /// 10694 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 10695 static ExprResult 10696 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 10697 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 10698 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 10699 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10700 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 10701 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 10702 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 10703 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 10704 // 10705 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 10706 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 10707 // 10708 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 10709 return ExprError(); 10710 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 10711 10712 CXXScopeSpec SS; 10713 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 10714 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 10715 10716 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 10717 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 10718 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10719 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 10720 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 10721 } 10722 10723 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 10724 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 10725 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 10726 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 10727 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 10728 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 10729 &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) && 10730 (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup( 10731 S, SS, R, 10732 MakeValidator(SemaRef, dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn), Args.size(), 10733 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, AllowTypoCorrection), 10734 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args))) 10735 return ExprError(); 10736 10737 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 10738 10739 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 10740 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 10741 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 10742 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 10743 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 10744 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 10745 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 10746 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 10747 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 10748 else 10749 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 10750 10751 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 10752 return ExprError(); 10753 10754 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 10755 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 10756 // end up here. 10757 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 10758 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 10759 RParenLoc); 10760 } 10761 10762 /// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 10763 /// the given function. 10764 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 10765 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 10766 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 10767 MultiExprArg Args, 10768 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 10769 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 10770 ExprResult *Result) { 10771 #ifndef NDEBUG 10772 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 10773 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 10774 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 10775 10776 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 10777 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 10778 FunctionDecl *F; 10779 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 10780 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 10781 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 10782 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 10783 10784 // We don't perform ADL in C. 10785 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 10786 } 10787 #endif 10788 10789 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 10790 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 10791 *Result = ExprError(); 10792 return true; 10793 } 10794 10795 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 10796 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 10797 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 10798 10799 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 10800 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 10801 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 10802 10803 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10804 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 10805 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best) == 10806 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 10807 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then 10808 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup 10809 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base 10810 // classes. 10811 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr( 10812 Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 10813 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 10814 CE->setValueDependent(true); 10815 CE->setInstantiationDependent(true); 10816 *Result = CE; 10817 return true; 10818 } 10819 } 10820 10821 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 10822 return false; 10823 10824 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10825 return false; 10826 } 10827 10828 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 10829 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 10830 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 10831 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 10832 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 10833 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 10834 MultiExprArg Args, 10835 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 10836 Expr *ExecConfig, 10837 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 10838 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 10839 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 10840 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 10841 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 10842 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 10843 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 10844 AllowTypoCorrection); 10845 10846 switch (OverloadResult) { 10847 case OR_Success: { 10848 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 10849 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 10850 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 10851 return ExprError(); 10852 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 10853 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 10854 ExecConfig); 10855 } 10856 10857 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 10858 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 10859 // have meant to call. 10860 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 10861 Args, RParenLoc, 10862 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 10863 AllowTypoCorrection); 10864 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 10865 return Recovery; 10866 10867 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 10868 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 10869 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 10870 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 10871 break; 10872 } 10873 10874 case OR_Ambiguous: 10875 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 10876 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 10877 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 10878 break; 10879 10880 case OR_Deleted: { 10881 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 10882 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted() 10883 << ULE->getName() 10884 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function) 10885 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 10886 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 10887 10888 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep 10889 // the call in the AST. 10890 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 10891 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 10892 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 10893 ExecConfig); 10894 } 10895 } 10896 10897 // Overload resolution failed. 10898 return ExprError(); 10899 } 10900 10901 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 10902 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 10903 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 10904 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 10905 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 10906 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 10907 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 10908 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 10909 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 10910 MultiExprArg Args, 10911 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 10912 Expr *ExecConfig, 10913 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 10914 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 10915 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 10916 ExprResult result; 10917 10918 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 10919 &result)) 10920 return result; 10921 10922 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10923 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 10924 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 10925 10926 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 10927 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, 10928 &Best, OverloadResult, 10929 AllowTypoCorrection); 10930 } 10931 10932 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 10933 return Functions.size() > 1 || 10934 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 10935 } 10936 10937 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 10938 /// operator. 10939 /// 10940 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 10941 /// 10942 /// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 10943 /// operator. 10944 /// 10945 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 10946 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 10947 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 10948 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 10949 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 10950 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 10951 /// 10952 /// \param Input The input argument. 10953 ExprResult 10954 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn, 10955 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 10956 Expr *Input) { 10957 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 10958 10959 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10960 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 10961 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 10962 // TODO: provide better source location info. 10963 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 10964 10965 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 10966 return ExprError(); 10967 10968 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 10969 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 10970 10971 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 10972 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 10973 // post-decrement. 10974 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 10975 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 10976 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 10977 SourceLocation()); 10978 NumArgs = 2; 10979 } 10980 10981 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 10982 10983 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 10984 if (Fns.empty()) 10985 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 10986 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc); 10987 10988 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 10989 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 10990 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 10991 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 10992 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 10993 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 10994 return new (Context) 10995 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy, 10996 VK_RValue, OpLoc, false); 10997 } 10998 10999 // Build an empty overload set. 11000 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 11001 11002 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 11003 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11004 11005 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 11006 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11007 11008 // Add candidates from ADL. 11009 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 11010 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 11011 CandidateSet); 11012 11013 // Add builtin operator candidates. 11014 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11015 11016 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11017 11018 // Perform overload resolution. 11019 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11020 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 11021 case OR_Success: { 11022 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 11023 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 11024 11025 if (FnDecl) { 11026 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 11027 // operator. 11028 11029 // Convert the arguments. 11030 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 11031 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 11032 11033 ExprResult InputRes = 11034 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 11035 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 11036 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 11037 return ExprError(); 11038 Input = InputRes.get(); 11039 } else { 11040 // Convert the arguments. 11041 ExprResult InputInit 11042 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 11043 Context, 11044 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 11045 SourceLocation(), 11046 Input); 11047 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 11048 return ExprError(); 11049 Input = InputInit.get(); 11050 } 11051 11052 // Build the actual expression node. 11053 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 11054 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 11055 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 11056 return ExprError(); 11057 11058 // Determine the result type. 11059 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 11060 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11061 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11062 11063 Args[0] = Input; 11064 CallExpr *TheCall = 11065 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, 11066 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false); 11067 11068 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 11069 return ExprError(); 11070 11071 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11072 } else { 11073 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 11074 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 11075 // operator node. 11076 ExprResult InputRes = 11077 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 11078 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 11079 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 11080 return ExprError(); 11081 Input = InputRes.get(); 11082 break; 11083 } 11084 } 11085 11086 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 11087 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 11088 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 11089 // defined too late to be candidates. 11090 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 11091 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 11092 return ExprError(); 11093 11094 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 11095 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 11096 break; 11097 11098 case OR_Ambiguous: 11099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 11100 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 11101 << Input->getType() 11102 << Input->getSourceRange(); 11103 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray, 11104 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 11105 return ExprError(); 11106 11107 case OR_Deleted: 11108 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 11109 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 11110 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 11111 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 11112 << Input->getSourceRange(); 11113 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, 11114 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 11115 return ExprError(); 11116 } 11117 11118 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 11119 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 11120 // build a built-in operation. 11121 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 11122 } 11123 11124 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 11125 /// operator. 11126 /// 11127 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 11128 /// 11129 /// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 11130 /// operator. 11131 /// 11132 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 11133 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 11134 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 11135 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 11136 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 11137 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 11138 /// 11139 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 11140 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 11141 ExprResult 11142 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 11143 unsigned OpcIn, 11144 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 11145 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 11146 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 11147 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 11148 11149 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 11150 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 11151 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 11152 11153 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 11154 // expression. 11155 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 11156 if (Fns.empty()) { 11157 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 11158 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 11159 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 11160 return new (Context) BinaryOperator( 11161 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 11162 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 11163 11164 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 11165 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, 11166 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc, 11167 FPFeatures.fp_contract); 11168 } 11169 11170 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 11171 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 11172 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 11173 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 11174 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 11175 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 11176 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 11177 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 11178 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 11179 return new (Context) 11180 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, 11181 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 11182 } 11183 11184 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 11185 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 11186 return ExprError(); 11187 11188 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 11189 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 11190 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 11191 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 11192 return ExprError(); 11193 11194 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 11195 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 11196 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 11197 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 11198 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 11199 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 11200 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 11201 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 11202 11203 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 11204 // create a built-in binary operator. 11205 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 11206 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 11207 11208 // Build an empty overload set. 11209 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 11210 11211 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 11212 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 11213 11214 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 11215 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 11216 11217 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 11218 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 11219 // which don't get here). 11220 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 11221 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 11222 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 11223 CandidateSet); 11224 11225 // Add builtin operator candidates. 11226 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 11227 11228 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11229 11230 // Perform overload resolution. 11231 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11232 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 11233 case OR_Success: { 11234 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 11235 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 11236 11237 if (FnDecl) { 11238 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 11239 // operator. 11240 11241 // Convert the arguments. 11242 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 11243 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 11244 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 11245 11246 ExprResult Arg1 = 11247 PerformCopyInitialization( 11248 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 11249 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 11250 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 11251 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 11252 return ExprError(); 11253 11254 ExprResult Arg0 = 11255 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 11256 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 11257 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 11258 return ExprError(); 11259 Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 11260 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 11261 } else { 11262 // Convert the arguments. 11263 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 11264 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 11265 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 11266 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 11267 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 11268 return ExprError(); 11269 11270 ExprResult Arg1 = 11271 PerformCopyInitialization( 11272 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 11273 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 11274 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 11275 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 11276 return ExprError(); 11277 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 11278 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 11279 } 11280 11281 // Build the actual expression node. 11282 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 11283 Best->FoundDecl, 11284 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 11285 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 11286 return ExprError(); 11287 11288 // Determine the result type. 11289 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 11290 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11291 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11292 11293 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 11294 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), 11295 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 11296 FPFeatures.fp_contract); 11297 11298 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 11299 FnDecl)) 11300 return ExprError(); 11301 11302 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 11303 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 11304 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) 11305 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 11306 11307 // Check for a self move. 11308 if (Op == OO_Equal) 11309 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 11310 11311 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ArgsArray, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, 11312 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply); 11313 11314 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11315 } else { 11316 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 11317 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 11318 // operator node. 11319 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 11320 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 11321 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 11322 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 11323 return ExprError(); 11324 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 11325 11326 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 11327 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 11328 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 11329 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 11330 return ExprError(); 11331 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 11332 break; 11333 } 11334 } 11335 11336 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 11337 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 11338 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 11339 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 11340 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 11341 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 11342 break; 11343 11344 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment 11345 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 11346 // no overloaded assignment operator found 11347 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 11348 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 11349 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 11350 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 11351 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 11352 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11353 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 11354 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 11355 << Args[0]->getType() 11356 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11357 } 11358 } else { 11359 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 11360 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 11361 // defined too late to be candidates. 11362 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 11363 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 11364 return ExprError(); 11365 11366 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 11367 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 11368 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 11369 } 11370 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 11371 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 11372 if (Result.isInvalid()) 11373 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 11374 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 11375 return Result; 11376 } 11377 11378 case OR_Ambiguous: 11379 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 11380 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 11381 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 11382 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11383 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 11384 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 11385 return ExprError(); 11386 11387 case OR_Deleted: 11388 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 11389 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 11390 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 11391 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent()) 11392 << getSpecialMember(Method); 11393 11394 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 11395 // explain why it's deleted. 11396 NoteDeletedFunction(Method); 11397 return ExprError(); 11398 } else { 11399 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 11400 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 11401 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 11402 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 11403 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11404 } 11405 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 11406 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 11407 return ExprError(); 11408 } 11409 11410 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 11411 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 11412 } 11413 11414 ExprResult 11415 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 11416 SourceLocation RLoc, 11417 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 11418 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 11419 DeclarationName OpName = 11420 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 11421 11422 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 11423 // expression. 11424 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 11425 11426 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 11427 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 11428 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 11429 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 11430 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 11431 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 11432 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 11433 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 11434 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 11435 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 11436 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 11437 11438 return new (Context) 11439 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args, 11440 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, false); 11441 } 11442 11443 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 11444 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 11445 return ExprError(); 11446 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 11447 return ExprError(); 11448 11449 // Build an empty overload set. 11450 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 11451 11452 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 11453 11454 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 11455 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 11456 11457 // Add builtin operator candidates. 11458 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 11459 11460 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11461 11462 // Perform overload resolution. 11463 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11464 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 11465 case OR_Success: { 11466 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 11467 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 11468 11469 if (FnDecl) { 11470 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 11471 // operator. 11472 11473 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 11474 11475 // Convert the arguments. 11476 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 11477 ExprResult Arg0 = 11478 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 11479 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 11480 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 11481 return ExprError(); 11482 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 11483 11484 // Convert the arguments. 11485 ExprResult InputInit 11486 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 11487 Context, 11488 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 11489 SourceLocation(), 11490 Args[1]); 11491 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 11492 return ExprError(); 11493 11494 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 11495 11496 // Build the actual expression node. 11497 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 11498 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 11499 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 11500 Best->FoundDecl, 11501 HadMultipleCandidates, 11502 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 11503 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 11504 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 11505 return ExprError(); 11506 11507 // Determine the result type 11508 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 11509 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11510 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11511 11512 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 11513 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 11514 FnExpr.get(), Args, 11515 ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 11516 false); 11517 11518 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 11519 return ExprError(); 11520 11521 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11522 } else { 11523 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 11524 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 11525 // operator node. 11526 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 11527 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 11528 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 11529 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 11530 return ExprError(); 11531 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 11532 11533 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 11534 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 11535 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 11536 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 11537 return ExprError(); 11538 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 11539 11540 break; 11541 } 11542 } 11543 11544 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 11545 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 11546 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 11547 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 11548 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11549 else 11550 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 11551 << Args[0]->getType() 11552 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11553 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 11554 "[]", LLoc); 11555 return ExprError(); 11556 } 11557 11558 case OR_Ambiguous: 11559 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 11560 << "[]" 11561 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 11562 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11563 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 11564 "[]", LLoc); 11565 return ExprError(); 11566 11567 case OR_Deleted: 11568 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 11569 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 11570 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 11571 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 11572 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 11573 "[]", LLoc); 11574 return ExprError(); 11575 } 11576 11577 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 11578 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 11579 } 11580 11581 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 11582 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 11583 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 11584 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 11585 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 11586 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 11587 /// member function. 11588 ExprResult 11589 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 11590 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11591 MultiExprArg Args, 11592 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 11593 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 11594 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 11595 11596 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 11597 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 11598 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 11599 11600 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 11601 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 11602 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 11603 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 11604 11605 QualType fnType = 11606 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 11607 11608 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11609 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 11610 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 11611 11612 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 11613 // member function we're calling. 11614 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals()); 11615 11616 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 11617 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 11618 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 11619 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 11620 11621 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 11622 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 11623 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 11624 if (difference) { 11625 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 11626 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 11627 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 11628 << qualsString 11629 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 11630 } 11631 11632 CXXMemberCallExpr *call 11633 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 11634 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc); 11635 11636 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(), 11637 call, nullptr)) 11638 return ExprError(); 11639 11640 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 11641 return ExprError(); 11642 11643 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 11644 return ExprError(); 11645 11646 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 11647 } 11648 11649 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 11650 return new (Context) 11651 CallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 11652 11653 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 11654 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 11655 return ExprError(); 11656 11657 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 11658 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 11659 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 11660 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 11661 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 11662 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 11663 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 11664 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 11665 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 11666 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 11667 } else { 11668 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 11669 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 11670 11671 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 11672 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 11673 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 11674 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 11675 11676 // Add overload candidates 11677 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 11678 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 11679 11680 // FIXME: avoid copy. 11681 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 11682 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11683 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 11684 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 11685 } 11686 11687 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 11688 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11689 11690 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 11691 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 11692 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 11693 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 11694 11695 11696 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 11697 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 11698 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), 11699 Args, CandidateSet); 11700 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 11701 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 11702 // non-template member function. 11703 if (TemplateArgs) 11704 continue; 11705 11706 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 11707 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 11708 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 11709 } else { 11710 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), 11711 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs, 11712 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 11713 Args, CandidateSet, 11714 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 11715 } 11716 } 11717 11718 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 11719 11720 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 11721 11722 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11723 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 11724 Best)) { 11725 case OR_Success: 11726 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 11727 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 11728 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 11729 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 11730 return ExprError(); 11731 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 11732 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 11733 // called on both. 11734 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 11735 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 11736 // being used. 11737 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 11738 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 11739 return ExprError(); 11740 break; 11741 11742 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 11743 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 11744 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 11745 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 11746 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11747 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 11748 return ExprError(); 11749 11750 case OR_Ambiguous: 11751 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 11752 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 11753 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11754 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 11755 return ExprError(); 11756 11757 case OR_Deleted: 11758 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 11759 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 11760 << DeclName 11761 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 11762 << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 11763 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11764 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 11765 return ExprError(); 11766 } 11767 11768 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 11769 11770 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 11771 // non-member call based on that function. 11772 if (Method->isStatic()) { 11773 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 11774 RParenLoc); 11775 } 11776 11777 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 11778 } 11779 11780 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 11781 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 11782 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11783 11784 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 11785 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 11786 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 11787 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 11788 11789 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 11790 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 11791 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) { 11792 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Method)) { 11793 Diag(MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target) 11794 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Method) << Method->getIdentifier() 11795 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller); 11796 return ExprError(); 11797 } 11798 } 11799 } 11800 11801 // Check for a valid return type. 11802 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 11803 TheCall, Method)) 11804 return ExprError(); 11805 11806 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 11807 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 11808 // it was done at lookup. 11809 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11810 ExprResult ObjectArg = 11811 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 11812 FoundDecl, Method); 11813 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 11814 return ExprError(); 11815 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 11816 } 11817 11818 // Convert the rest of the arguments 11819 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 11820 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11821 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 11822 RParenLoc)) 11823 return ExprError(); 11824 11825 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 11826 11827 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 11828 return ExprError(); 11829 11830 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 11831 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 11832 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors 11833 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 11834 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 11835 Diag(MemExprE->getLocStart(), 11836 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 11837 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 11838 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 11839 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) 11840 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 11841 return ExprError(); 11842 } 11843 } 11844 11845 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 11846 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 11847 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 11848 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 11849 11850 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 11851 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 11852 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 11853 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 11854 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 11855 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 11856 11857 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 11858 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 11859 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 11860 diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 11861 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName() 11862 << MD->getDeclName(); 11863 } 11864 } 11865 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11866 } 11867 11868 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 11869 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 11870 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 11871 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 11872 ExprResult 11873 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 11874 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11875 MultiExprArg Args, 11876 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 11877 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 11878 return ExprError(); 11879 ExprResult Object = Obj; 11880 11881 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 11882 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 11883 return ExprError(); 11884 11885 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 11886 "Requires object type argument"); 11887 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 11888 11889 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 11890 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 11891 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 11892 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 11893 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 11894 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 11895 // (E).operator(). 11896 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 11897 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 11898 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 11899 11900 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 11901 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 11902 return true; 11903 11904 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 11905 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 11906 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 11907 11908 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 11909 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 11910 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 11911 Object.get()->Classify(Context), 11912 Args, CandidateSet, 11913 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false); 11914 } 11915 11916 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 11917 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 11918 // declared in T of the form 11919 // 11920 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 11921 // 11922 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 11923 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 11924 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 11925 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 11926 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 11927 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 11928 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 11929 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 11930 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 11931 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 11932 // within T by another intervening declaration. 11933 const auto &Conversions = 11934 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 11935 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11936 NamedDecl *D = *I; 11937 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 11938 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 11939 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 11940 11941 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 11942 // surrogates. 11943 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 11944 continue; 11945 11946 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 11947 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 11948 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 11949 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 11950 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11951 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11952 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11953 11954 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11955 { 11956 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 11957 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 11958 } 11959 } 11960 } 11961 11962 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11963 11964 // Perform overload resolution. 11965 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11966 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(), 11967 Best)) { 11968 case OR_Success: 11969 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 11970 // below. 11971 break; 11972 11973 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 11974 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 11975 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 11976 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 11977 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 11978 else 11979 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 11980 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 11981 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 11982 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11983 break; 11984 11985 case OR_Ambiguous: 11986 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 11987 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 11988 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 11989 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 11990 break; 11991 11992 case OR_Deleted: 11993 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 11994 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 11995 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 11996 << Object.get()->getType() 11997 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 11998 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 11999 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12000 break; 12001 } 12002 12003 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 12004 return true; 12005 12006 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12007 12008 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 12009 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 12010 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 12011 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 12012 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 12013 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 12014 12015 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 12016 Best->FoundDecl); 12017 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 12018 return ExprError(); 12019 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 12020 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 12021 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 12022 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 12023 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 12024 12025 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 12026 // and then call it. 12027 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 12028 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 12029 if (Call.isInvalid()) 12030 return ExprError(); 12031 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 12032 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 12033 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 12034 nullptr, VK_RValue); 12035 12036 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 12037 } 12038 12039 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 12040 12041 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 12042 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 12043 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 12044 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12045 12046 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 12047 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 12048 return ExprError(); 12049 12050 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 12051 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12052 12053 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 12054 12055 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 12056 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 12057 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 12058 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 12059 HadMultipleCandidates, 12060 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 12061 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 12062 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12063 return true; 12064 12065 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 12066 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 12067 std::unique_ptr<Expr * []> MethodArgs(new Expr *[Args.size() + 1]); 12068 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 12069 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]); 12070 12071 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 12072 // owned. 12073 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 12074 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12075 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12076 12077 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) 12078 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), 12079 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1), 12080 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false); 12081 MethodArgs.reset(); 12082 12083 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 12084 return true; 12085 12086 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 12087 // slots in the call for them. 12088 if (Args.size() < NumParams) 12089 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1); 12090 12091 bool IsError = false; 12092 12093 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 12094 ExprResult ObjRes = 12095 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12096 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12097 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 12098 IsError = true; 12099 else 12100 Object = ObjRes; 12101 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get()); 12102 12103 // Check the argument types. 12104 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 12105 Expr *Arg; 12106 if (i < Args.size()) { 12107 Arg = Args[i]; 12108 12109 // Pass the argument. 12110 12111 ExprResult InputInit 12112 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 12113 Context, 12114 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 12115 SourceLocation(), Arg); 12116 12117 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 12118 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 12119 } else { 12120 ExprResult DefArg 12121 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 12122 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 12123 IsError = true; 12124 break; 12125 } 12126 12127 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 12128 } 12129 12130 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 12131 } 12132 12133 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 12134 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 12135 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 12136 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 12137 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 12138 nullptr); 12139 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 12140 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get()); 12141 } 12142 } 12143 12144 if (IsError) return true; 12145 12146 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 12147 12148 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 12149 return true; 12150 12151 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12152 } 12153 12154 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 12155 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 12156 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 12157 ExprResult 12158 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12159 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 12160 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 12161 "left-hand side must have class type"); 12162 12163 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 12164 return ExprError(); 12165 12166 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 12167 12168 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 12169 // 12170 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 12171 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 12172 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 12173 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 12174 DeclarationName OpName = 12175 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 12176 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12177 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 12178 12179 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 12180 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 12181 return ExprError(); 12182 12183 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 12184 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 12185 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12186 12187 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 12188 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 12189 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 12190 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 12191 } 12192 12193 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12194 12195 // Perform overload resolution. 12196 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12197 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 12198 case OR_Success: 12199 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 12200 break; 12201 12202 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12203 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 12204 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 12205 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 12206 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 12207 // diagnostic, as requested. 12208 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 12209 return ExprError(); 12210 } 12211 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 12212 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 12213 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 12214 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 12215 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 12216 } 12217 } else 12218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 12219 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 12220 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 12221 return ExprError(); 12222 12223 case OR_Ambiguous: 12224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 12225 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 12226 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base); 12227 return ExprError(); 12228 12229 case OR_Deleted: 12230 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12231 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12232 << "->" 12233 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12234 << Base->getSourceRange(); 12235 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 12236 return ExprError(); 12237 } 12238 12239 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 12240 12241 // Convert the object parameter. 12242 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12243 ExprResult BaseResult = 12244 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12245 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12246 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 12247 return ExprError(); 12248 Base = BaseResult.get(); 12249 12250 // Build the operator call. 12251 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 12252 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 12253 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12254 return ExprError(); 12255 12256 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 12257 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12258 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12259 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 12260 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), 12261 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false); 12262 12263 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 12264 return ExprError(); 12265 12266 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12267 } 12268 12269 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 12270 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 12271 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 12272 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 12273 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 12274 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 12275 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 12276 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 12277 12278 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 12279 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 12280 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, TemplateArgs, 12281 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true); 12282 12283 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12284 12285 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 12286 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 12287 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12288 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 12289 case OR_Success: 12290 case OR_Deleted: 12291 break; 12292 12293 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12294 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 12295 << R.getLookupName(); 12296 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12297 return ExprError(); 12298 12299 case OR_Ambiguous: 12300 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName(); 12301 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 12302 return ExprError(); 12303 } 12304 12305 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 12306 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 12307 HadMultipleCandidates, 12308 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 12309 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 12310 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 12311 return true; 12312 12313 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 12314 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 12315 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 12316 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 12317 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 12318 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 12319 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 12320 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 12321 return true; 12322 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 12323 } 12324 12325 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 12326 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12327 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12328 12329 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = 12330 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(), 12331 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), 12332 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 12333 12334 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 12335 return ExprError(); 12336 12337 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 12338 return ExprError(); 12339 12340 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 12341 } 12342 12343 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 12344 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 12345 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 12346 /// dependent lookup. 12347 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 12348 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 12349 /// is returned. 12350 Sema::ForRangeStatus 12351 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 12352 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl, 12353 BeginEndFunction BEF, 12354 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 12355 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 12356 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12357 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 12358 CandidateSet->clear(); 12359 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 12360 ExprResult MemberRef = 12361 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 12362 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 12363 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 12364 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 12365 MemberLookup, 12366 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 12367 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 12368 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 12369 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range) 12370 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType(); 12371 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 12372 } 12373 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 12374 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 12375 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 12376 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range) 12377 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType(); 12378 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 12379 } 12380 } else { 12381 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames; 12382 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = 12383 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 12384 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo, 12385 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false, 12386 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end()); 12387 12388 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 12389 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 12390 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 12391 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 12392 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 12393 } 12394 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12395 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 12396 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 12397 12398 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 12399 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 12400 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 12401 } 12402 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 12403 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 12404 OverloadResult, 12405 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 12406 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 12407 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 12408 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range) 12409 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType(); 12410 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 12411 } 12412 } 12413 return FRS_Success; 12414 } 12415 12416 12417 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 12418 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 12419 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 12420 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 12421 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 12422 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 12423 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 12424 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 12425 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 12426 Found, Fn); 12427 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 12428 return PE; 12429 12430 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 12431 } 12432 12433 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 12434 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 12435 Found, Fn); 12436 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 12437 SubExpr->getType()) && 12438 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 12439 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 12440 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 12441 return ICE; 12442 12443 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 12444 ICE->getCastKind(), 12445 SubExpr, nullptr, 12446 ICE->getValueKind()); 12447 } 12448 12449 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 12450 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 12451 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 12452 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 12453 if (Method->isStatic()) { 12454 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 12455 // from non-member functions. 12456 } else { 12457 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 12458 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 12459 // or template. 12460 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 12461 Found, Fn); 12462 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 12463 return UnOp; 12464 12465 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 12466 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 12467 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 12468 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 12469 12470 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 12471 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 12472 // appropriate pointer to member type. 12473 QualType ClassType 12474 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 12475 QualType MemPtrType 12476 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 12477 12478 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 12479 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 12480 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 12481 } 12482 } 12483 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 12484 Found, Fn); 12485 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 12486 return UnOp; 12487 12488 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 12489 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 12490 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 12491 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 12492 } 12493 12494 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 12495 // FIXME: avoid copy. 12496 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 12497 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12498 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 12499 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 12500 } 12501 12502 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 12503 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), 12504 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 12505 Fn, 12506 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME? 12507 ULE->getNameLoc(), 12508 Fn->getType(), 12509 VK_LValue, 12510 Found.getDecl(), 12511 TemplateArgs); 12512 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 12513 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 12514 return DRE; 12515 } 12516 12517 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 12518 // FIXME: avoid copy. 12519 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 12520 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12521 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 12522 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 12523 } 12524 12525 Expr *Base; 12526 12527 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 12528 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 12529 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 12530 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 12531 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 12532 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 12533 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 12534 Fn, 12535 /*enclosing*/ false, 12536 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12537 Fn->getType(), 12538 VK_LValue, 12539 Found.getDecl(), 12540 TemplateArgs); 12541 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 12542 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 12543 return DRE; 12544 } else { 12545 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 12546 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 12547 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 12548 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc); 12549 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 12550 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 12551 /*isImplicit=*/true); 12552 } 12553 } else 12554 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 12555 12556 ExprValueKind valueKind; 12557 QualType type; 12558 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 12559 valueKind = VK_LValue; 12560 type = Fn->getType(); 12561 } else { 12562 valueKind = VK_RValue; 12563 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 12564 } 12565 12566 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create( 12567 Context, Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 12568 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 12569 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), TemplateArgs, type, valueKind, 12570 OK_Ordinary); 12571 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 12572 MarkMemberReferenced(ME); 12573 return ME; 12574 } 12575 12576 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 12577 } 12578 12579 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 12580 DeclAccessPair Found, 12581 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 12582 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 12583 } 12584